Casio Credit Card Machine QT 2100 User Manual

QT-2100  
Versatile Intelligent Terminal  
————————————————————————  
Programming Manual  
Version 1.0 February 2002  
Key Assign  
000.NOP  
001.CASH  
002.CHARGE  
006.NB  
003.CHECK  
008.PRCINQ  
011.PRT  
004.CREDIT  
009.STKINQ  
012.CHKP  
010.CHAR  
013.CLK TRAN  
016.NRMRCT  
014.TBL TRAN 015.TIP  
SIT  
REG1 CSpagetti  
01  
10-10-01 12:34 001234  
$20.00 T1  
v
1 Spagetti  
$20.00 T1  
.00  
Date  
Time  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
-1.50  
ID Character  
MC #01  
$8.00  
Check System  
No.  
Master  
Descriptor  
Qty  
Price  
@1,234.00  
@1.00  
KP S
PLU0001
$2.00 T1  
1
R/J/
PLU0001  
12.26  
0.00  
Slip
2
PLU0002  
@20.00  
@2.00  
Rear
PLU0002  
Remo
-0.30  
$2.00  
$5.00  
$8.00  
3
P
OK?  
Record No.1  
P
X
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
P
4
X/For  
P
X/XX  
P
5
X/XXX  
P
Ketten Bo
Table Range  
P
6
Selective
New Check  
Old Check  
C$8.00  
New/Old C
Enter Start range  
1
Add Check  
End  
range  
123  
2n
Separate
1
76.50  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
c
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preface  
P-3  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
1. Machine Initialization................................................................ P-8  
1-1. How to initialize QT-2100 terminal .............................................................P-8  
1-2. How to initialize QT-2100 terminal (add/replace one QT-2100) ............... P-11  
1-3. How to flag clear QT-2100 terminal (or INIT2) .........................................P-14  
2. Program 5 ................................................................................ P-16  
2-1. Programming memory allocation (daily & program).................................P-16  
2-2. Programming memory allocation (periodic & work) .................................P-17  
2-3. Programming memory allocation file by file .............................................P-18  
3. Program 4 ................................................................................ P-24  
3-1. Programming key allocation.....................................................................P-24  
3-2. Programming key allocation (key location change) .................................P-26  
3-3. Programming key allocation.....................................................................P-28  
4. Program 3 ................................................................................ P-34  
4-1. Programming machine features...............................................................P-34  
4-1-1 Programming pulldown group (adding/modifying/deleting group item) ......P-34  
4-1-2 Programming set menu table .....................................................................P-36  
4-1-3 Programming arrangement ........................................................................P-38  
4-1-4 Programming batch X/Z report ...................................................................P-39  
4-1-5 Programming the general feature...............................................................P-41  
4-1-6 Programming scheduler .............................................................................P-58  
4-1-7 Programming check print ...........................................................................P-60  
4-1-8 Programming table analysis .......................................................................P-61  
4-1-9 Programming tax table ...............................................................................P-62  
4-1-10 Programming void table .............................................................................P-65  
4-1-11 Programming system connection ...............................................................P-66  
4-1-12 Programming I/O parameter.......................................................................P-67  
4-1-13 Programming printer connection ................................................................P-70  
4-1-14 Programming time zone .............................................................................P-71  
4-1-15 Programming time & attendance................................................................P-72  
4-1-16 Programming hourly item link.....................................................................P-76  
4-1-17 Programming IDC link ................................................................................P-77  
4-1-18 Programming Euro .....................................................................................P-78  
4-1-19 Programming auto program control............................................................P-79  
4-2. Programming clerks .................................................................................P-80  
4-2-1 Programming clerk features .......................................................................P-80  
4-2-2 Programming operation..............................................................................P-82  
4-2-3 Programming commission rate...................................................................P-92  
4-2-4 Programming table range...........................................................................P-93  
4-2-5 Programming clerk by range ......................................................................P-94  
4-2-6 Programming clerk detail..........................................................................P-106  
4-2-7 Programming clerk key ID ........................................................................P-107  
P-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
4-3. Programming key features.....................................................................P-108  
4-3-1 Programming PLU features......................................................................P-108  
4-3-2 Programming PLU 2nd@ features ........................................................... P-110  
4-3-3 Programming subdepartment features ..................................................... P-111  
4-3-4 Programming department features........................................................... P-112  
4-3-5 Programming by range ............................................................................. P-113  
4-3-6 Programming individual program ............................................................. P-116  
4-3-7 Programming key function program ......................................................... P-117  
4-3-8 Programming shift PLU program ..............................................................P-135  
4-3-9 Programming scanning PLU link program................................................P-136  
5. Program 2 .............................................................................. P-140  
5-1. Character programming .........................................................................P-140  
5-1-1 Character programming keyboard............................................................P-140  
5-1-2 Inputting characters by code ....................................................................P-142  
5-1-3 After completing to input characters .........................................................P-142  
5-2. Programming item descriptors ...............................................................P-143  
5-2-1 Programming PLU item descriptors .........................................................P-143  
5-2-2 Programming PLU 2nd unit price descriptors...........................................P-144  
5-2-3 Programming subdepartment descriptors ................................................P-144  
5-2-4 Programming department descriptors ......................................................P-145  
5-2-5 Programming PLU/subdepartment/department descriptors by range ......P-146  
5-2-6 Copying PLU descriptors to PLU 2nd unit price .......................................P-147  
5-2-7 Programming function key descriptors .....................................................P-148  
5-3. Programming characters and messages ...............................................P-149  
5-3-1 Programming receipt message, slip message and guest receipt messageP-149  
5-3-2 Programming text recall message ............................................................P-150  
5-3-3 Programming order character link ............................................................P-150  
5-3-4 Programming fixed totalizer descriptors ...................................................P-151  
5-3-5 Programming group character..................................................................P-152  
5-3-6 Programming special characters ..............................................................P-152  
5-3-7 Programming report headers ...................................................................P-154  
5-3-8 Programming endorsement message ......................................................P-155  
5-3-9 Programming GT character ......................................................................P-155  
6. Program 1 .............................................................................. P-158  
6-1. Presetting date and time ........................................................................P-158  
6-2. Programming unit price and rate............................................................P-159  
6-2-1 Programming PLU unit price ....................................................................P-159  
6-2-2 Programming PLU 2nd unit price .............................................................P-160  
6-2-3 Programming PLU unit price and PLU 2nd unit price...............................P-161  
6-2-4 Programming subdepartment unit price ...................................................P-162  
6-2-5 Programming department unit price .........................................................P-162  
6-2-6 Programming PLU/PLU 2nd@/subdepartment/  
department unit price by range................................................................P-163  
6-2-7 Copying PLU unit price to PLU 2nd unit price ..........................................P-165  
6-2-8 Programming amount or rate to keys .......................................................P-166  
6-2-9 Programming unit price of shift PLU.........................................................P-167  
P-5  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
7. Program 6 .............................................................................. P-170  
7-1. Program read general procedure...........................................................P-170  
7-2. Program read report sample ..................................................................P-171  
7-2-1 Unit Price/Qty ...........................................................................................P-171  
7-2-2 Item Descriptor .........................................................................................P-172  
7-2-3 Character and Message ...........................................................................P-172  
7-2-4 Machine feature........................................................................................P-176  
7-2-5 Clerk .......................................................................................................P-208  
7-2-6 Key feature ...............................................................................................P-220  
7-2-7 Keyboard ..................................................................................................P-242  
7-2-8 Memory allocation ....................................................................................P-242  
Index .............................................................................................. P-244  
Program 3 mode Hierarchy .................................................................................P-247  
Program 1 mode Hierarchy .................................................................................P-248  
Program 2 mode Hierarchy .................................................................................P-248  
Program 6 mode Hierarchy .................................................................................P-248  
P-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1. Machine Initialization.................................................................P-8  
1-1. How to initialize QT-2100 terminal ............................................................. P-8  
1-2. How to initialize QT-2100 terminal (add/replace one QT-2100) ................P-11  
1-3. How to flag clear QT-2100 terminal (or INIT2) ......................................... P-14  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initialization  
1. Machine Initialization  
1-1. How to initialize QT-2100 terminal  
Preparation:  
1. All peripheral devices and QT-2100 terminals of this cluster  
should be turned off.  
2. Connect all of the peripheral devices (such as printer, display  
etc.) to QT-2100 terminal.  
3. Connect all QT-2100 terminals by inline.  
Operation:  
4. Turn on all peripheral devices of a QT-2100 terminal.  
5. Turn on this QT-2100 terminal with pressing the left-most  
key of the top row and release the key after buzzer sounds.  
6. After releasing the key, enter “2000” (U.S.)/“1000” (other  
area) and press the <ST> key.  
Date  
Time  
00-00-00  
12:34 00  
ID
Date  
01-10-10  
Ch
Time  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
Master  
0
Ch
ID Character  
R/
Check System  
R/
Check cluster ID  
R/
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
Sl
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
OK
Slip Printer  
OK?  
SP-1300  
YES  
7. Enter the current date (YY/MM/DD order) and time and  
press the <YES> key.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check cluster ID  
Check System  
Master  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
OK?  
YES  
8. In ID character field, the auto-defined ID No. is shown.  
We recommend that you should not change the value.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check cluster ID  
Check System  
Master  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
9. In this field, the check cluster No, should be set, if your check  
tracking system are divided in some clusters.  
OK?  
YES  
(Enter cluster No. “1” ~ “9”, if you use check cluster system.)  
P-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check cluster ID  
Check System  
Master  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
10. In this field, you can select “1. Master/2. Backup Master/3.  
Satellite/4.Selfmaster.”  
OK?  
YES  
Please select one of these options and press the <YES> key.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check cluster ID  
Check System  
Master  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
OK?  
YES  
11. In these fields, you can select, “1. No/2. UP-350/3. SA-3015/  
4. UP-250” for R/J/Order printer.  
Please select one of these options and press the <YES> key.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
0
Time  
Check cluster ID  
ID Character  
Check System  
MC #01  
Master  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
OK?  
YES  
12. In this field, you can select, “1. No/2. SA-3015/3. SP-1300”  
for slip printer.  
Please select one of these options and press the <YES> key.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
0
Time  
Check cluster ID  
ID Character  
Check System  
MC #01  
Master  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
OK?  
YES  
13. Please confirm all of the field and if they are all right, press  
the <YES> key to proceed the next step.  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
AUTO PGM  
YES  
1.No Restore/Receive  
2.PGM Restore (CF Card)  
3.PGM Receive (Inline)  
14. If you want to download program data from other terminal or  
CF card, select the appropriate menu and press the <YES>  
key and proceed the next step.  
If you don't need to download any program data, just select  
“1. No Restore/Receive” and press the <YES> key.  
If you have another machine to initialize, return to step 4.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initialization  
Program copy from other terminal.  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
Received Data  
All PGM  
MC #05  
PGM Receive from  
OK?  
YES  
15. In this field, you can select the receiving contents as “1. All  
Data (including totalizer)/2. All PGM (program only).”  
0.00  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
Received Data  
All PGM  
MC #05  
PGM Receive from  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
16. Inthisfield,youshouldenterthesourceIDnumberofthedata  
and press the <YES> key.  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
Received Data  
All PGM  
MC #05  
PGM Receive from  
OK?  
YES  
17. Please confirm all of the fields and if they are all right, press  
the <YES> key to proceed downloading.  
Aftercompletionofdownloading, returntostep4toinitialize  
other terminals.  
0.00  
Restore from CF card.  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
Data Restore  
1.PLUPGM1 .004  
2.PLUPGM2 .004  
3.STORE-AA.090  
4.STORE-BB.090  
15. Insert the CF card into the slot and select the appropriate file  
and press the <YES> key.  
0.00  
STORE-AAA.090  
Are you sure to restore?  
16. After the confirmation window is shown, press the <YES>  
key to proceed restoring.  
0.00  
Aftercompletionofdownloading, returntostep4toinitialize  
other terminals.  
P-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. How to initialize QT-2100 terminal (add/replace one QT-2100)  
Preparation:  
1. All peripheral devices and QT-2100 terminals of this cluster  
should be turned off.  
2. Connect all of the peripheral devices (such as printer, display  
etc.) to this QT-2100 terminal.  
3. Connect this QT-2100 terminal to inline.  
Operation:  
4. Turn on all peripheral devices of this QT-2100 terminal.  
And turn on all QT-2100 except this terminal of the cluster.  
5. Turn on this QT-2100 terminal with pressing the left-most  
key of the top row and release the key after buzzer sounds.  
6. After releasing the key, enter “2000” (U.S.)/“1000” (other  
area) and press the <ST> key.  
Date  
Time  
00-00-00  
12:34 00  
ID
Ch
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
Master  
0
Ch
Time  
R/
ID Character  
R/
Check System  
R/
Check cluster ID  
Sl
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
OK
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
OK?  
YES  
7. Enter the current date (YY/MM/DD order) and time and  
press the <YES> key.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check cluster ID  
Check System  
Master  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
OK?  
YES  
8. In ID character field, the auto-defined ID No. is shown.  
Please check if the same value is set in this field.  
We recommend that you should not change the value.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
Master  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check System  
Check cluster ID  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
9. In this field, you can select “1. Master/2. Backup Master/3.  
Satellite/4.Selfmaster.”  
OK?  
YES  
Please choose former options and press the <YES> key.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
Master  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check System  
Check cluster ID  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
10. In this field, the check cluster No, should be set, if your check  
tracking system are divided in some clusters.  
OK?  
YES  
(Enter cluster No. “1” ~ “9”, if you use check cluster system.)  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initialization  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
Master  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check System  
Check cluster ID  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SA-1300  
11. In these fields, you can select, “1. No/2. UP-350/3. SA-3015/  
4. UP-250” for R/J/Order printer.  
OK?  
YES  
Please choose former option and press the <YES> key.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
Master  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check System  
Check cluster ID  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
12. In this field, you can select, “1. No/2. SA-3015/3. SP-1300”  
for slip printer.  
OK?  
YES  
Please choose former options and press the <YES> key.  
Date  
01-10-10  
12:34 00  
MC #01  
Master  
0
Time  
ID Character  
Check System  
Check cluster ID  
R/J/Order Printer(1) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(2) UP-350  
R/J/Order Printer(3) UP-350  
Slip Printer  
SP-1300  
OK?  
YES  
13.Please confirm all of the field and if they are all right, press the  
<YES> key to proceed the next step.  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
AUTO PGM  
YES  
1.No Restore/Receive  
2.PGM Restore (CF Card)  
3.PGM Receive (Inline)  
14. If you want to download program data from other terminal or  
CF card, select the appropriate menu and press the <YES>  
key and proceed the next step.  
If you don't need to download any program data, just select  
“1. No Restore/Receive” and press the <YES> key. (The  
initialization is completed.)  
P-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program copy from other terminal.  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
Received Data  
All PGM  
MC #05  
PGM Receive from  
OK?  
YES  
15. In this field, you can select the receiving contents as “1. All  
Data (including totalizer)/2. All PGM (program only).”  
0.00  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
Received Data  
All PGM  
MC #05  
PGM Receive from  
OK?  
YES  
16. Inthisfield,youshouldenterthesourceIDnumberofthedata  
and press the <YES> key.  
0.00  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
Received Data  
All PGM  
MC #05  
PGM Receive from  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
17. Please confirm all of the fields and if they are all right, press  
the <YES> key to proceed downloading. (The initialization  
is completed.)  
Restore from CF card.  
INIT  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
Data Restore  
1.PLUPGM1 .004  
2.PLUPGM2 .004  
3.STORE-AA.090  
4.STORE-BB.090  
15. Insert the CF card into the slot and select the appropriate file  
and press the <YES> key.  
0.00  
STORE-AAA.090  
Are you sure to restore?  
0.00  
16. After the confirmation window is shown, press the <YES>  
key to proceed restoring. (The initialization is completed.)  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initialization  
1-3. How to flag clear QT-2100 terminal (or INIT2)  
Preparation:  
1. All peripheral devices and this QT-2100 terminal should be  
turned off.  
2. Check the connection of all peripheral devices (such as  
printer, display etc.) of this QT-2100 terminal.  
3. Check the connection of this QT-2100 terminal to inline.  
Operation:  
4. Turn on all peripheral devices of this QT-2100 terminal.  
5. Turn on this QT-2100 terminal with pressing the right-most  
key of the top row and release the key after buzzer sounds.  
6. After releasing the key, press the <ST> key.  
10-10-01 12:34  
INIT  
1.Flag Clear  
2.INIT2  
0.00  
7. Select “1. Flag Clear” and press the <YES> key.  
The flag clear operation is finished.  
Note:  
Performing “Init 2” requires password “8888888888” .  
P-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Program 5 .................................................................................P-16  
2-1. Programming memory allocation (daily & program)................................. P-16  
2-2. Programming memory allocation (periodic & work) ................................. P-17  
2-3. Programming memory allocation file by file ............................................. P-18  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 5  
2. Program 5  
2-1. Programming memory allocation (daily & program)  
Operation:  
P5C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
PGM-5  
1.Memory Alloc  
0.00  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 5 mode.  
Memory Alloc  
Memory Alloc  
1.Daily & PGM  
2.Periodic & Work  
3.Individual File  
0.00  
3. Select 1. Daily & PGMand press the <YES> key.  
Daily & PGM  
Daily & PGM  
Daily & PGM  
Cashier/Clerk  
15  
3
Scanning PLU link  
100^  
20  
30  
0
Order Chara Link  
10^  
10  
Check Tracking Tables  
Pulldown Group  
Set Menu Table  
Sub-Department  
Department  
Void File  
Items/Table  
Item Blocks  
60  
Free Function  
Time Zone  
100  
1
0
Table Analysis  
PLU  
10  
4
Hourly Production  
Hourly Labor  
Employee  
0
324  
324  
108v  
Group  
20  
12  
99v  
0
PLU 2nd@  
Shift PLU  
Receipt/SLIP Msg  
Text Recall  
0
Job Code  
0v  
RAM  
22688  
RAM  
22688  
RAM  
22688  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
The remainder of memory  
Daily & PGM  
Hourly Production  
Hourly Labor  
Employee  
0^  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
4. Select an appropriate file, enter the record numbers you want  
to allocate and press the <YES> key.  
The lowest row shows the remaining memory.  
5. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Job Code  
IDC Link  
IDC(1)  
IDC(2)  
IDC(3)  
RAM  
22688  
0.00  
P-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-2. Programming memory allocation (periodic & work)  
Operation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P5C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
PGM-5  
1.Memory Alloc  
0.00  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 5 mode.  
Memory Alloc  
Memory Alloc  
1.Daily & PGM  
2.Periodic & Work  
3.Individual File  
0.00  
3. Select 2. Periodic & Workand press the <YES> key.  
Periodic & Work  
PLU  
Periodic(1) Totalizer  
Periodic(2) Totalizer  
Consolidation & Work  
Except PLU  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Periodic(1) Totalizer  
Periodic(2) Totalizer  
Consolidation & Work  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
RAM  
22688  
0.00  
4. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES> (allocate)  
or <NO> (not allocate) key.  
5. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Note:  
The Flag Clear operation resets YESstatus. However it does not reallocate the files that  
were already allocated on this screen.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 5  
2-3. Programming memory allocation file by file  
If you want to allocate files file by file, follow the procedures below.  
Operation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P5C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
PGM-5  
1.Memory Alloc  
0.00  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 5 mode.  
Memory Alloc  
Memory Alloc  
1.Daily & PGM  
2.Periodic & Work  
3.Individual File  
0.00  
3. Select 3. Individual Fileand press the <YES> key.  
Individual File  
File001  
File101  
File201  
File301  
File401  
File501  
File601  
File002  
78  
78  
0
78  
78  
0
78  
70  
RAM  
612  
0.00  
4. Select the file number you want to change and enter record  
number you want to allocate (0means file deletion).  
5. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
File  
No.  
Record Max. No. Work  
Attribu-  
tion  
Allocat-  
able  
File description  
Description  
length of records  
size  
System files  
901  
902  
903  
904  
999  
System connection table  
I/O parameter  
Printer connection  
Consecutive number  
System error log  
18  
5
27  
6
33  
15  
99  
5
75  
69  
81  
69  
75  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Buffer  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
11  
20  
Buffer  
Function and total files  
001  
101  
201  
301  
401  
501  
601  
002  
102  
202  
302  
402  
502  
602  
003  
103  
203  
303  
403  
503  
603  
004  
104  
204  
304  
404  
504  
604  
005  
105  
205  
305  
405  
505  
605  
006  
106  
206  
306  
406  
506  
606  
009  
109  
209  
309  
409  
509  
609  
010  
110  
Fixed totalizer  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Free function  
26  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
38  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
54  
15  
15  
15  
15  
15  
15  
92  
30  
30  
30  
30  
30  
30  
54  
15  
15  
15  
15  
15  
15  
26  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
20  
20  
20  
20  
20  
20  
20  
20  
20  
78  
78  
78  
78  
78  
81  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
99  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
135  
81  
81  
81  
81  
81  
81  
177  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
135  
81  
81  
81  
81  
81  
81  
81  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
87  
87  
87  
87  
87  
87  
87  
87  
87  
Pgm/Sales  
Sales  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
78  
78  
Buffer  
Pgm/Sales  
Sales  
999  
999  
999  
999  
999  
999  
999  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Subdepaprtment  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
Buffer  
Pgm/Sales  
Sales  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
PLU  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
99  
99  
Buffer  
Pgm/Sales  
Sales  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Department  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
Buffer  
Pgm/Sales  
Sales  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Group  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
Buffer  
Pgm/Sales  
Sales  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Buffer  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Buffer  
Sales  
Sales  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Hourly sales  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
99  
96  
96  
96  
96  
96  
96  
96  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Monthly sales  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
32  
32  
(periodic total 1)  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 5  
File  
Record Max. No. Work  
Attribu-  
tion  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Allocat-  
able  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
File description  
Description  
No.  
210  
310  
410  
510  
610  
012  
112  
212  
312  
412  
512  
612  
018  
118  
218  
318  
418  
518  
618  
020  
120  
220  
320  
420  
520  
620  
055  
155  
255  
355  
455  
555  
655  
Clerk  
007  
030  
027  
011  
111  
211  
311  
411  
511  
611  
length of records  
size  
(periodic total 2)  
20  
20  
20  
20  
20  
29  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
32  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
24  
8
32  
32  
32  
32  
32  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
87  
87  
87  
87  
87  
87  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
93  
75  
75  
75  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Void reason  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
Sales  
Buffer  
Pgm/Sale  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Buffer  
Pgm/Sale  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Buffer  
Pgm/Sale  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Buffer  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Table analysis  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Grand total  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
75  
75  
75  
75  
99  
99  
3
3
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
69  
8
3
69  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Shift PLU  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
8
3
69  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
8
3
69  
8
3
69  
8
3
69  
91  
70  
70  
70  
70  
70  
70  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
189  
147  
147  
147  
147  
147  
147  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
Buffer  
Clerk  
95  
4
99  
99  
200  
9801  
9801  
9801  
9801  
9801  
9801  
9801  
165  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Buffer  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Clerk detail link  
Clerk (Dallas) key ID  
Clerk detail  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
14  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
Time & Attendance  
014  
114  
214  
314  
414  
514  
614  
019  
319  
800  
801  
802  
Hourly / Labor  
26  
26  
26  
26  
26  
26  
26  
18  
18  
6
96  
96  
96  
96  
96  
96  
96  
4158  
4158  
24  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
99  
111  
75  
81  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Buffer  
Sales  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Work time  
(daily consolidation)  
Time zone  
Employee  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
Sales  
Program  
Program  
Program  
36  
22  
99  
50  
135  
87  
Job code  
Note: Never allocate Shift PLUfiles, if you use Accumulation for menu totaling specification.  
P-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
File  
No.  
803  
Record Max. No. Work  
Attribu-  
tion  
Program  
Buffer  
Allocat-  
able  
Yes  
File description  
Schedule  
Description  
length of records  
size  
111  
657  
11  
99  
2079  
1
806  
Time & Attendance work  
Yes  
Check  
015  
060  
Check Index  
Check detail  
Check detail work  
300  
80  
80  
200  
9999  
2000  
69  
69  
69  
Buffer  
Buffer  
Buffer  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
066  
Hourly item  
021  
121  
221  
321  
421  
521  
621  
031  
Hourly item  
(periodic total 1)  
(periodic total 2)  
(daily consolidation)  
(periodic 1 consolidation)  
(periodic 2 consolidation)  
(consolidation work)  
Hourly item link  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
4
1920  
1920  
1920  
1920  
1920  
1920  
1920  
480  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
75  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Buffer  
Program  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
IDC  
057  
357  
657  
058  
358  
658  
059  
359  
659  
063  
804  
IDC (1)  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
6
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
999  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
81  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Sales  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
(consolidation file)  
(consolidation work)  
IDC (2)  
(consolidation file)  
(consolidation work)  
IDC (3)  
(consolidation file)  
(consolidation work)  
IDC buffer  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
for master  
Buffer  
Program  
IDC link  
Program / message / buffer  
016  
022  
023  
024  
025  
026  
028  
029  
032  
033  
035  
036  
039  
041  
044  
047  
048  
648  
054  
062  
065  
074  
099  
905  
Scanning PLU link  
General control  
Special character  
Report header  
9
6
300  
37  
58  
31  
10  
999  
999  
10  
48  
4
999  
2000  
9999  
9
1000  
432/864  
1000  
12336  
9999  
99  
75  
69  
69  
69  
93  
189  
183  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
99  
75  
69  
171  
69  
75  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Buffer  
Yes  
No  
No  
16  
16  
74  
103  
80  
9
40  
40  
80  
80  
40  
3
40  
13  
41  
41  
46  
14  
16  
36  
4
No  
Tax table  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Pulldown group  
Set menu table  
Batch X/Z  
Receipt/slip message  
Endorse message  
Print buffer  
Registration buffer  
Character recall  
Check print  
Display buffer  
Graphic logo  
Electronic journal memory  
Electronic journal (collection)  
PLU 2nd @  
Buffer  
Program  
Program  
Buffer  
Program  
Buffer  
for master  
Buffer  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Scheduler  
Order character  
Key table  
Euro program  
Auto program control  
99  
192  
3
Yes  
Yes  
3
20  
Arrangement  
038  
138  
238  
338  
438  
Arrange group (1)  
24  
24  
24  
24  
24  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
9999  
69  
69  
69  
69  
69  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Program  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Arrange group (2)  
Arrange group (3)  
Arrange group (4)  
Arrange group (5)  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 5  
P-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Program 4 ................................................................................. P-24  
3-1. Programming key allocation..................................................................... P-24  
3-2. Programming key allocation (key location change).................................. P-26  
3-3. Programming key allocation..................................................................... P-28  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 4  
3. Program 4  
3-1. Programming key allocation  
Operation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P4C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
PGM-4  
1.Keyboard  
0.00  
2. Put the first level menu sheet on the keyboard.  
3. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 4 mode.  
Keyboard  
Keyboard  
1.Key Assign  
2.Key Move  
0.00  
4. Select 1. Key Assignand press the <YES> key.  
Key Assign  
001.CASH  
000.NOP  
002.CHARGE  
003.CHECK  
008.PRCINQ  
011.PRT  
004.CREDIT  
009.STKINQ  
012.CHKP  
006.NB  
010.CHAR  
013.CLK TRAN  
016.NRMRCT  
021.PD  
014.TBL TRAN 015.TIP  
019.LOAN  
022.P.UP.  
027.-  
020.RC  
023.COUPON  
028.%-  
025.DEPOSIT  
029.+  
030.%+  
033.RF  
034.VOID  
038.RCT  
036.CPN2  
039.CK.E  
037.VLD  
040.#  
041.#/NS  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate function and press the <YES> key.  
Then press the corresponding key.  
Orselectanappropriatefunctionbythefunctioncodelist(see  
the next page) and press the corresponding key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Function  
Add check  
Code  
094  
044  
047  
109  
236  
001  
002  
039  
012  
003  
072  
013  
108  
023  
036  
004  
090  
045  
043  
051  
135  
025  
028  
219  
140  
128  
207  
034  
069  
063  
114  
113  
136  
137  
019  
000  
118  
064  
080  
027  
082  
006  
091  
093  
016  
042  
040  
041  
103  
092  
Initial character  
ADD CHK  
Function  
Code  
067  
068  
117  
078  
073  
021  
022  
029  
048  
115  
030  
008  
049  
083  
131  
038  
076  
020  
033  
206  
116  
119  
070  
085  
095  
065  
054  
056  
055  
084  
009  
130  
133  
134  
111  
075  
058  
014  
129  
057  
077  
062  
011  
010  
074  
015  
037  
046  
122  
Initial character  
OPEN  
Open  
OPEN2  
OPEN CHK  
OPE#  
ARG  
Arrangement  
Bill copy  
Open2  
BILL  
Open Check  
Operator number  
Operator read/reset  
Paid out  
BREAK-IN/OUT  
CANCEL  
CASH  
Break-in/out  
Cancel  
OPE X/Z  
PD  
Cash amount tendered  
Charge  
P.UP  
CHARGE  
CK.E  
Pick up  
+
Check endorsement  
Check print  
Check tender  
Clerk number  
Clerk transfer  
Clock-in/out  
Coupon  
Plus  
PLU#  
CHKP  
PLU  
POST ENTRY  
%+  
CHECK  
CLK#  
Post Entry  
Premium  
PRCINQ  
PRC  
CLK TRANS  
CLOCK-IN/OUT  
COUPON  
CPN2  
Price inquiry  
Price  
QT  
Quantity/For  
Recall  
RECALL  
RCT  
Coupon 2  
CREDIT  
XXX  
Credit  
Receipt  
RCT ON/OFF  
RC  
Cube  
Receipt On/OFF  
Received on account  
Refund  
CE  
Currency exchange  
Customer number  
Department  
Department number  
Deposit  
RF  
CT  
REVERSE  
R REPEAT  
SEAT#  
2nd@  
DEPT nn  
DEPT#  
DEPOSIT  
%–  
Reverse Display  
Round Repeat  
Seat number  
Second unit price  
Selective item subtotal  
Separate check  
Shift PLU  
Discount  
SIST  
DISP MODE  
DUTCH  
EAT-IN  
EJ DISP  
VOID  
Display mode  
Dutch account  
Eat-in  
SEP CHK  
SFT PLU  
SB/R  
Electronic journal Disp  
Error correct/Void  
First unit price  
Flat PLU  
Slip back feed/Release  
Slip feed/Release  
Slip print  
SF/R  
SLIP  
1st@  
XX  
PLU nnnn  
HOUSE BON  
X/KETTEN  
LIST  
Square  
STKINQ  
STORE  
SUBDEPT nn  
SDPT#  
SUBST.  
SUBTOTAL  
TBL#  
House Bon  
Stock inquiry  
Store  
Ketten Bon  
List  
Subdepartment  
Subdepartment number  
Substitution  
Subtotal  
LIST#  
LOAN  
List number  
Loan  
NOP  
Lock out unused key  
Media change  
Menu shift  
MEDIA CHG  
MENU  
Table number  
Table transfer  
Take-out  
TABLE TRANS  
TAKE-OUT  
T/S  
MDST  
Merchandise subtotal  
Minus  
Tax status shift  
Taxable amount subtotal  
Tax exempt  
Text print  
TAST  
X
Multiplication  
New balance  
New check  
EXEMPT  
PRT  
NB  
NEW CHK  
NEW/OLD  
NRMRCT  
NS  
CHAR  
New/Old check  
Normal receipt  
No sale  
Text recall  
TRAY TTL  
TIP  
Tray total  
Tip  
VLD  
#
Non-add  
Validation  
VAT  
#/NS  
Non-add/No sale  
OBR  
VAT  
X/Z MODE  
OBR  
X/Z mode  
OLD CHK  
Old check  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 4  
3-2. Programming key allocation (key location change)  
Operation:  
P4C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
PGM-4  
1.Keyboard  
0.00  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 4 mode.  
Keyboard  
Keyboard  
1.Key Assign  
2.Key Move  
0.00  
3. Select 2. Key Moveand press the <YES> key.  
Key Move  
Please Press the key which  
you want to move.  
0.00  
4. Press the first key you want to change.  
Key Move  
Press the new position  
of the key.  
0.00  
5. Press the second key you want to change.  
P-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Key Move  
CASH  
<-> CHARGE  
Move OK? (YES/NO)  
0.00  
6. Press the <YES> key after confirmation.  
7. Press <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Keyboard layout  
The shadowed key cannot be programmed with any other functions.  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
18  
17  
16  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
27  
26  
25  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
36  
35  
34  
33  
32  
31  
30  
29  
28  
45  
44  
43  
42  
41  
40  
39  
38  
37  
54  
53  
52  
51  
50  
49  
48  
47  
46  
63  
62  
61  
60  
59  
58  
57  
56  
55  
72  
71  
70  
69  
68  
67  
66  
65  
64  
81  
80  
79  
78  
77  
76  
75  
74  
73  
90  
89  
88  
87  
86  
85  
84  
83  
82  
99  
98  
97  
96  
85  
94  
93  
92  
91  
108  
107  
106  
105  
104  
103  
102  
101  
100  
1
19  
REG  
ESC/  
SKIP  
MENU  
SHIFT  
NEW/OLD  
TABLE  
TRANS  
#/NS  
CANCEL VAT  
CLK5  
c x VOID  
7 8 9  
4 5 6  
1 2 3  
0 00 •  
MODE  
CHK  
X/Z  
MODE  
HOUSE  
BON  
ADD  
CHK  
SEAT  
No.  
PD  
COVERS  
CH  
CR  
RC  
CLK4  
CLK3  
CLK2  
CLK1  
PGM  
MODE  
PAGE  
UP  
SEP  
CHK  
SUBTOTAL  
NO  
DISP  
ON/OFF  
CASH AMT  
TEND  
SUBST.  
CHK  
HOME  
PAGE  
DOWN  
GUEST  
RECEIPT  
%–  
NB  
YES  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 4  
3-3. Programming key allocation  
Programming different function on the same location of the different menu sheet level.  
Method 1  
Operation:  
First of all, programming one function on one menu sheet by the method of Section 3-1.  
Next, issue 5. Function Keyreport in the 5. Key Featureof the PGM Read Report”  
in PGM 6 mode.  
And open the function key allocation screen.  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P4C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
PGM-4  
1.Keyboard  
0.00  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 4 mode.  
Keyboard  
Keyboard  
1.Key Assign  
2.Key Move  
0.00  
3. Select 1. Key Assignand press the <YES> key.  
Key Assign  
001.CASH  
000.NOP  
002.CHARGE  
003.CHECK  
008.PRCINQ  
011.PRT  
004.CREDIT  
009.STKINQ  
012.CHKP  
006.NB  
010.CHAR  
013.CLK TRAN  
016.NRMRCT  
021.PD  
014.TBL TRAN 015.TIP  
019.LOAN  
022.P.UP.  
027.-  
020.RC  
023.COUPON  
028.%-  
025.DEPOSIT  
029.+  
030.%+  
033.RF  
034.VOID  
038.RCT  
036.CPN2  
039.CK.E  
037.VLD  
040.#  
4. Enter the appropriate record number (in 4-digits) and func-  
tion code (in 3-digits) and press the corresponding key on the  
appropriate menu sheet.  
041.#/NS  
v
0.00  
5. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Method 2  
Operation:  
In case of allocating different functions from the functions of the same location on the first  
level menu sheet, turn the menu sheet or press the <MENU> key and allocate the function  
on the menu sheet which you want to put.  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P4C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
PGM-4  
1.Keyboard  
0.00  
2. Put on the menu sheet you want to program.  
3. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 4 mode.  
Keyboard  
Keyboard  
1.Key Assign  
2.Key Move  
0.00  
4. Select 1. Key Assignand press the <YES> key.  
Key Assign  
001.CASH  
000.NOP  
002.CHARGE  
003.CHECK  
008.PRCINQ  
011.PRT  
004.CREDIT  
009.STKINQ  
012.CHKP  
006.NB  
010.CHAR  
013.CLK TRAN  
016.NRMRCT  
021.PD  
014.TBL TRAN 015.TIP  
019.LOAN  
022.P.UP.  
027.-  
020.RC  
023.COUPON  
028.%-  
025.DEPOSIT  
029.+  
030.%+  
033.RF  
034.VOID  
038.RCT  
036.CPN2  
039.CK.E  
037.VLD  
040.#  
041.#/NS  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate function and press the <YES> key.  
Then press the corresponding key.  
Orselectanappropriatefunctionbythefunctioncodelist(see  
the previous page) and press the corresponding key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 4  
P-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Program 3 ................................................................................. P-34  
4-1. Programming machine features ............................................................... P-34  
4-1-1  
4-1-2  
4-1-3  
4-1-4  
Programming pulldown group (adding/modifying/deleting group item)......... P-34  
Programming set menu table........................................................................ P-36  
Programming arrangement ........................................................................... P-38  
Programming batch X/Z report...................................................................... P-39  
Programming the general feature ................................................................. P-41  
Programming the machine control 1 ............................................................. P-41  
Programming the machine control 2 ............................................................. P-42  
Programming the machine control 3 ............................................................. P-44  
Programming the machine control 4 ............................................................. P-45  
Programming the print control....................................................................... P-46  
Programming the report control 1 ................................................................. P-47  
Programming the report control 2 ................................................................. P-48  
Programming the communication ................................................................. P-49  
Programming the hourly sales ...................................................................... P-50  
4-1-5  
4-1-5-1  
4-1-5-2  
4-1-5-3  
4-1-5-4  
4-1-5-5  
4-1-5-6  
4-1-5-7  
4-1-5-8  
4-1-5-9  
4-1-5-10 Programming the slip/guest .......................................................................... P-50  
4-1-5-11 Programming the journal control................................................................... P-51  
4-1-5-12 Programming the message control ............................................................... P-52  
4-1-5-13 Programming the order control ..................................................................... P-52  
4-1-5-14 Programming the set menu/condiment ......................................................... P-53  
4-1-5-15 Programming the check tracking .................................................................. P-54  
4-1-5-16 Programming the clerk interrupt.................................................................... P-54  
4-1-5-17 Programming the display control .................................................................. P-55  
4-1-5-18 Programming the menu shift 1...................................................................... P-56  
4-1-5-19 Programming the menu shift 2...................................................................... P-57  
4-1-6  
4-1-7  
4-1-8  
4-1-9  
4-1-10  
4-1-11  
4-1-12  
4-1-13  
4-1-14  
4-1-15  
Programming scheduler................................................................................ P-58  
Programming check print .............................................................................. P-60  
Programming table analysis.......................................................................... P-61  
Programming tax table.................................................................................. P-62  
Programming void table ................................................................................ P-65  
Programming system connection.................................................................. P-66  
Programming I/O parameter ......................................................................... P-67  
Programming printer connection................................................................... P-70  
Programming time zone................................................................................ P-71  
Programming time & attendance .................................................................. P-72  
4-1-15-1 Programming time & attendance (general) .................................................. P-72  
4-1-15-2 Programming time & attendance (job code) ................................................. P-73  
4-1-15-3 Programming time & attendance (employee & schedule)............................. P-74  
4-1-16  
4-1-17  
4-1-18  
4-1-19  
Programming hourly item link ....................................................................... P-76  
Programming IDC link................................................................................... P-77  
Programming Euro........................................................................................ P-78  
Programming auto program control .............................................................. P-79  
4-2. Programming clerks ................................................................................. P-80  
4-2-1  
4-2-2  
4-2-2-1  
4-2-2-2  
4-2-2-3  
Programming clerk features.......................................................................... P-80  
Programming operation ................................................................................ P-82  
Programming clerk control ............................................................................ P-82  
Programming menu shift/2nd@ .................................................................... P-83  
Programming mode control........................................................................... P-84  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-2-4  
4-2-2-5  
4-2-2-6  
4-2-2-7  
4-2-2-8  
4-2-2-9  
Programming function control 1 .................................................................... P-85  
Programming function control 2 .................................................................... P-86  
Programming function control 3 .................................................................... P-87  
Programming function control 4 .................................................................... P-88  
Programming function control 5 .................................................................... P-89  
Programming arrangement control ............................................................... P-90  
4-2-2-10 Programming X/Z report control.................................................................... P-91  
4-2-3  
4-2-4  
4-2-5  
Programming commission rate ..................................................................... P-92  
Programming table range ............................................................................. P-93  
Programming clerk by range......................................................................... P-94  
Programming clerk control by range ............................................................. P-94  
Programming menu shift/2nd@ by range ..................................................... P-95  
Programming mode control by range............................................................ P-96  
Programming function control 1 by range ..................................................... P-97  
Programming function control 2 by range ..................................................... P-98  
Programming function control 3 by range ..................................................... P-99  
Programming function control 4 by range ................................................... P-100  
Programming function control 5 by range ................................................... P-101  
Programming arrangement control by range .............................................. P-102  
4-2-5-1  
4-2-5-2  
4-2-5-3  
4-2-5-4  
4-2-5-5  
4-2-5-6  
4-2-5-7  
4-2-5-8  
4-2-5-9  
4-2-5-10 Programming X/Z report control by range................................................... P-103  
4-2-5-11 Programming commission rate by range .................................................... P-104  
4-2-5-12 Programming table range by range ............................................................ P-105  
4-2-6  
4-2-7  
Programming clerk detail ............................................................................ P-106  
Programming clerk key ID........................................................................... P-107  
4-3. Programming key features ..................................................................... P-108  
4-3-1  
4-3-2  
4-3-3  
4-3-4  
4-3-5  
4-3-5-1  
Programming PLU features ........................................................................ P-108  
Programming PLU 2nd@ features...............................................................P-110  
Programming subdepartment features ........................................................ P-111  
Programming department features ..............................................................P-112  
Programming by range ................................................................................P-113  
General procedure of PLU, PLU 2nd@, subdepartment,  
department by range...................................................................................P-114  
Programming hierarchy of programming title...............................................P-115  
Programming individual program .................................................................P-116  
Programming key function program.............................................................P-117  
Worksheet for cash, charge, credit and check .............................................P-118  
Worksheet for new balance .........................................................................P-119  
Worksheet for text print, text recall ............................................................. P-120  
Worksheet for check print ........................................................................... P-121  
Worksheet for clerk transfer ........................................................................ P-121  
Worksheet for table transfer........................................................................ P-121  
Worksheet for tip ......................................................................................... P-121  
Worksheet for loan, pick up ........................................................................ P-122  
Worksheet for received on account, paid out.............................................. P-122  
4-3-5-2  
4-3-6  
4-3-7  
4-3-7-1  
4-3-7-2  
4-3-7-3  
4-3-7-4  
4-3-7-5  
4-3-7-6  
4-3-7-7  
4-3-7-8  
4-3-7-9  
4-3-7-10 Worksheet for plus, minus, coupon............................................................. P-123  
4-3-7-11 Worksheet for deposit+, deposit– ............................................................... P-124  
4-3-7-12 Worksheet for void ...................................................................................... P-124  
4-3-7-13 Worksheet for check endorsement ............................................................. P-124  
4-3-7-14 Worksheet for discount, premium ............................................................... P-125  
4-3-7-15 Worksheet for receipt .................................................................................. P-126  
P-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-16 Worksheet for non-add, non-add/NS .......................................................... P-126  
4-3-7-17 Worksheet for customer .............................................................................. P-127  
4-3-7-18 Worksheet for arrangement ........................................................................ P-127  
4-3-7-19 Worksheet for currency exchange .............................................................. P-128  
4-3-7-20 Worksheet for slip ....................................................................................... P-128  
4-3-7-21 Worksheet for T/S, TAST ............................................................................ P-128  
4-3-7-22 Worksheet for open..................................................................................... P-129  
4-3-7-23 Worksheet for open 2.................................................................................. P-129  
4-3-7-24 Worksheet for clerk number ........................................................................ P-130  
4-3-7-25 Worksheet for operator X/Z......................................................................... P-130  
4-3-7-26 Worksheet for subtotal, merchandise subtotal ............................................ P-130  
4-3-7-27 Worksheet for cancel .................................................................................. P-131  
4-3-7-28 Worksheet for multiplication, quantity/for, square, cube, Ketten Bon.......... P-131  
4-3-7-29 Worksheet for selective item subtotal ......................................................... P-131  
4-3-7-30 Worksheet for open check .......................................................................... P-131  
4-3-7-31 Worksheet for list ........................................................................................ P-131  
4-3-7-32 Worksheet for tax exempt ........................................................................... P-132  
4-3-7-33 Worksheet for clock-in/clock-out ................................................................. P-132  
4-3-7-34 Worksheet for break-in/break-out ............................................................... P-132  
4-3-7-38 Worksheet for round repeat ........................................................................ P-133  
4-3-7-35 Worksheet for eat-in/take-out...................................................................... P-133  
4-3-7-36 Worksheet for store..................................................................................... P-133  
4-3-7-37 Worksheet for new check, new/old check ................................................... P-133  
4-3-7-39 Worksheet for shift PLU .............................................................................. P-134  
4-3-7-40 Worksheet for receipt on/off ........................................................................ P-134  
4-3-7-41 Worksheet for old check ............................................................................. P-134  
4-3-7-42 Worksheet for Dutch account...................................................................... P-134  
4-3-7-43 Worksheet for tray total ............................................................................... P-134  
4-3-7-44 Worksheet for recall .................................................................................... P-134  
4-3-8  
4-3-9  
Programming shift PLU program ................................................................ P-135  
Programming scanning PLU link program .................................................. P-136  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4. Program 3  
4-1. Programming machine features  
Preparation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 3 mode.  
P3C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
PGM-3  
1.Machine Feature  
2.Clerk  
3.Key Feature  
0.00  
3. Select 1. Machine Featureand press the <YES> key.  
4-1-1 Programming pulldown group (adding/modifying/deleting group item)  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Pulldown Group  
Pulldown Group  
Machine Feature  
1.Pulldown Group  
2.Set Menu Table  
3.Arrangement  
1.LIST01  
2.LIST02  
3.LIST03  
4.LIST04  
5.LIST05  
6.LIST06  
7.LIST07  
8.LIST08  
4.Batch X/Z  
5.General Feature  
6.Scheduler  
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
v
v
0.00  
0.00  
4. Select 1.Pulldown Groupand press the <YES> key.  
5. Select an appropriate pulldown group and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. If it is necessary to modify the message, press the <YES> key  
first to enter the characters, and then press the <YES> key.  
Pulldown Group  
List Title : LIST01  
0001-026  
Number of Stay down (Max)  
Number of Stay down (Min)  
0
0
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
Field meaning  
1. Number of stay down (Min):  
0 = Status, 1 ~ 8 = The number of times for stay down, 9 = No limit  
2. Number of stay down (Max):  
0 = Status, 1 ~ 8 = The number of times for stay down, 9 = No limit  
P-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Addition/Modification  
LIST01  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
9.  
10.  
11.  
0.0v0  
7. Selectarecordyouwanttoaddanitemormodifytheitemand  
press the <YES> key.  
LIST01  
Item  
1.PLU  
2.Pulldown Group  
0.00  
8. Select 1. PLUor 2. Pull Down Groupyou want to  
program.  
LIST01  
LIST01  
PLU  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
Pulldown Group  
1.LIST01  
2.LIST02  
3.LIST03  
4.LIST04  
5.LIST05  
6.LIST06  
7.LIST07  
8.PLU0008  
v
8.LIST08  
v
0.00  
0.00  
LIST01  
Use LIST Key (if NOLIST#)  
OK? YES  
9. To select an appropriate PLU as an item, select a PLU  
directly, enter PLU No. and press the <PLU> key or press the  
appropriate <FLAT PLU> key.  
10. Repeat step 7 to 9, until completing this pulldown group item  
program.  
11. Press the <ESC> key to terminate the program and proceed  
the next step.  
12. If you want to use the <LIST> key, press the <YES> key.  
After that, select a <LIST> key by pressing the appropriate  
key. When the key you pressed is already used, choose YES  
to overwrite.  
0.00  
LIST01  
13. If you do not want to use <LIST> key, press the <NO> key.  
14. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
This Key is Already Used.  
Overwrite OK? (YES/NO)  
0.00  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
Deletion  
LIST01  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
9.  
10.  
11.  
0.0v0  
7. Selectthefirstrecordofitemsyouwanttodeleteandpressthe  
<NO> key.  
LIST01  
Item 01-02 Delete OK?  
YES  
0.00  
8. Press the <YES> key.  
The selected item and followings are deleted.  
9. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
4-1-2 Programming set menu table  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
1.Pulldown Group  
2.Set Menu Table  
3.Arrangement  
4.Batch X/Z  
5.General Feature  
6.Scheduler  
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
v
0.00  
4. Select 2. Set Menu Tableand press the <YES> key.  
Set Menu Table  
Set Menu Table  
1.Set Menu (0001)  
2.Set Menu (0002)  
3.Set Menu (0003)  
4.Set Menu (0004)  
5.Set Menu (0005)  
6.Set Menu (0006)  
7.Set Menu (0007)  
8.Set Menu (0008)  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate set menu item and press the <YES>  
key.  
P-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Addition/Modification  
Set Menu Table (0001)  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
9.  
10.  
11.  
0.0v0  
6. Select an item record you want to add or modify and  
press the <YES> key.  
Set Menu Table (0001)  
Item  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.List  
0.00  
7. Select 1. PLU, 2. PLU 2nd@or 3. Listyou want to  
program.  
Set Menu Table (0001)  
Set Menu Table (0001)  
PLU  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
LIST  
1.LIST01  
2.LIST02  
3.LIST03  
4.LIST04  
5.LIST05  
6.LIST06  
7.LIST07  
8.PLU0008  
v
8.LIST08  
v
0.00  
0.00  
8. ToselectanappropriatePLUorPLU2md@asanitem,select  
a PLU directly, enter PLU No. and press the <PLU> key or  
press the appropriate <Touch PLU> key.  
Set Menu Table (0001)  
Link:PLU0001  
OK:  
0001-04  
YES  
To select a list as an item, press the <LIST> key or enter the  
significant list number, then press the <LIST #> key.  
9. Repeat step 6 to 8, until completing this set menu item  
program.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to terminate the program and proceed  
the next step.  
0.00  
11. If you want to change the main PLU, press the <YES> key.  
Set Menu Table (0001)  
PLU  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
0.00  
12. Select the main PLU and press the <YES> key.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
Deletion  
Set Menu Table (0001)  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
9.  
10.  
11.  
0.0v0  
6. Select the smallest record you want to delete the item(s) and  
press the <NO> key.  
Set Menu Table (0001)  
Item 01-02 Delete OK? YES  
0.00  
7. Press the <YES> key.  
8. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
4-1-3 Programming arrangement  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
1.Pulldown Group  
2.Set Menu Table  
3.Arrangement  
4.Batch X/Z  
5.General Feature  
6.Scheduler  
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
v
0.00  
4. Select 3. Arrangementand press the <YES> key.  
Arrangement  
Arrangement  
1.ARG GP1  
2.ARG GP2  
3.ARG GP3  
4.ARG GP4  
5.ARG GP5  
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES> key.  
P-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ARG GP1  
0001-038  
0002-038  
0003-038  
0004-038  
0005-038  
0006-038  
0007-038  
0008-038  
0009-038  
0010-038  
0011-038  
6. Press the <YES> key, enter arrangement commands by  
character and press the <YES> key.  
0.0v0  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
4-1-4 Programming batch X/Z report  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
1.Pulldown Group  
2.Set Menu Table  
3.Arrangement  
4.Batch X/Z  
5.General Feature  
6.Scheduler  
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
v
0.00  
4. Select 4. Batch X/Zand press the <YES> key.  
Batch X/Z  
0001-029  
0002-029  
0003-029  
0004-029  
001112151700000000  
101112151700000000  
011112151700000000  
111112151700000000  
5. Select an appropriate record, enter the report code (refer to  
the next page) and press the <YES> key.  
0.00  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow to issue read report.  
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D18  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Allow to issue reset report.  
Read = 0  
Reset = 4  
Read/Reset selection (direct issuance)  
Reported area:  
Daily area = 0, Periodic 1 area = 1,  
Periodic 2 area = 2, Consolidation area = 3  
Significant  
number  
:
D17  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
Report code 1  
Report code 2  
Report code 3  
Report code 4  
Report code 5  
Report code 6  
Report code 7  
Report code 8  
D16 D15  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D14 D13  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D12 D11  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D10 D9  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D8 D7  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D4 D3  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
Report  
Report code  
Fixed totalizer report  
Function key report  
Subdepartment report  
PLU report  
11  
12  
13  
14  
64  
15  
16  
17  
19  
20  
22  
28  
58  
29  
24  
31  
PLU stock report  
Department report  
Group report  
Cashier/clerk report  
Hourly sales report  
Monthly sales report  
Void reason report  
Table analysis report  
Electronic journal report  
Employee (all) report  
Hourly/labor report  
Hourly item report  
P-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-5 Programming the general feature  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
1.Pulldown Group  
2.Set Menu Table  
3.Arrangement  
4.Batch X/Z  
5.General Feature  
6.Scheduler  
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
v
0.00  
4. Select 5. General Featureand press the <YES> key.  
4-1-5-1 Programming the machine control 1  
General Feature  
General Feature  
1.Machine Control1  
2.Machine Control2  
3.Machine Control3  
4.Machine Control4  
5.Print Control  
6.Report Control1  
7.Report Control2  
8.Communiction  
v
0.00  
5. Select 1. Machine Control1and press the <YES> key.  
Machine Control1  
Machine Control1  
Machine No.  
0
Country Rounding  
None  
VAT  
Order of Date  
DD/MM/YY  
Add2  
Tax System  
Add Mode  
Disable to amount tender in RF  
/REG- mode  
Reset consecutive number to  
initial value after taking  
daily fixed totallizer report  
Initial value for consecutive  
number  
YES  
VLD compulsory & Drawer Open  
No  
At Once  
Money-in-drawer limit alarm  
Maximum value of left most  
digit (0 to 9)  
0
None  
VAT  
Country Rounding  
0
Tax System  
Money-in-drawer limit alarm  
Number of Zeros (0 to 9)  
Disable to amount tender in RF  
v
0
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Machine number: (0 - 9999)  
Not the ID code but the printing machine number.  
2. Add mode:  
You can choose Add 2 (ex. dollar and cent), Add 0 (ex. Japanese yen) or Add 1.  
3. Reset the consecutive No. to initial value after taking daily fixed totalizer report:  
Consecutive No. starts preset value +1. (Initial consecutive number: 1 - 999999.)  
4. Country Rounding:  
You can choose None, IF1, IF2, Danish, Norwegian/Swedish, Singapore.  
5. Tax systems:  
You can choose VAT/US/Canada/Singapore tax system.  
6. VLD compulsory and drawer open:  
You can choose At onceand After compulsory.”  
7. Money-in-drawer limit alarm:  
You can enter Maximum value of left-most digitand The number of zeros.”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-5-2 Programming the machine control 2  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
1.Machine Control1  
2.Machine Control2  
3.Machine Control3  
4.Machine Control4  
5.Print Control  
6.Report Control1  
7.Report Control2  
8.Communication  
v
0.00  
5. Select 2. Machine Control2and press the <YES> key.  
Machine Control2  
Display Operator Guidance  
Sequencial / Ramdom PLU number  
Machine Control2  
YES  
result  
NO^  
Restriction(0 or 5)on the last  
digit for amount entry  
Money Declaration Compulsory  
ST Compulsory  
Use memory number  
Include  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Net total Includes Tax  
Net total Includes Commission  
+,- Follows Tax Status of item  
+,-,%+&%- amount in item net  
totalizer  
Include  
YES  
Allow Finalization operation  
when subtotal is zero or less  
Allow more than one tran-  
saction in RF mode  
YES  
N Repeat  
NOv  
NO  
NO  
Limit of number +,-,%+&%- key  
operations per transaction  
Round of %+ or %- operation  
Issue post receipt  
v
when normal receipt is issued  
0.00  
0.00  
Machine Control2  
Allow numeric entry when com-  
pulsory drawer is open  
Error when actual stock less  
than zero  
Machine Control2  
Perform stock QTY calculation  
during RF mode or RF key  
Delete RF items from guest  
receipt when item  
^
^
YES  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Alarm when actual stock less  
than minimum stock level  
Perform stock QTY calculation  
during RF mode or RF key  
Delete RF items from guest  
receipt when item  
consolidation is on  
YES  
YES  
NO  
Key Confirmation Tone On  
Allow Slit Drawer connection  
Add No. of operation of clear  
key into Fixed TTL  
NO  
YES  
NO  
Use YES key to select item  
Inline Money Declaration  
consolidation is on  
0.Y0ES0v  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Sequencial/Random PLU number:  
You can choose Use memory numberor Use Random code.”  
2. Net total includes tax:  
Net total includes add-on tax amount.  
If select No, add-in tax amount is also excluded.  
3. Net total includes commission:  
Net total includes clerk commission.  
4. Plus/minus follows tax status of item:  
The tax status and commission status of plus/minus after item registration follows the  
last item.  
5. Plus, minus, premium, discount amount in item net totalizer:  
Affect premium, discount, plus, minus result to the original item.  
6. Limit of number plus, minus, premium, discount key operations per transaction:  
Only one premium, discount, plus or minus registration is permitted during one  
receipt.  
P-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Round of Premium or Discount operation:  
Rounding on the least significant digit of Premium or Discount registration.  
8. Restrict (0 or 5) on the last digit for amount entry:  
The least significant digit for monetary amount entries is restricted to 0 or 5.  
9. Money declaration compulsory:  
Moneydeclarationbeforedailyread/resetoperationorcolection/consolidationopera-  
tion (inline money declaration) is mandatory or not.  
10. ST compulsory:  
ST key operation before finalization is mandatory or not.  
11. Allow finalization operation when subtotal is zero or less:  
Allow/prohibit finalization operation when the subtotal amount is zero or less.  
12. Allow more than one transaction in RF mode:  
Prohibit/allow multiple refund operations after entering the RF mode.  
13. Issue Post receipt when normal receipt is issued:  
Allow/prohibit post receipt after a normal receipt issuance.  
14. Allow numeric entries when compulsory drawer is open:  
Allow/prohibit numeric entries when drawer (compulsory drawer only) is opened.  
15. Alarm when actual stock less than zero:  
Error occurs when actual stock for a registered item becomes negative.  
16. Error when actual stock less than minimum stock level:  
Error occurs when actual stock for a registered item drops below its programmed  
optimum stock value.  
17. Perform stock QTY calculation during RF mode or RF key:  
Affect to stock value during RF key and the RF mode operation.  
18. Delete RF items from guest receipt when its consolidation is on:  
Merge the same department/PLU registration of a guest receipt.  
19. Use YES key to select item:  
Pressing the <YES> key is required when you select an item. If Nois selected,  
<YES> key is not necessary to press.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-5-3 Programming the machine control 3  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
1.Machine Control1  
2.Machine Control2  
3.Machine Control3  
4.Machine Control4  
5.Print Control  
6.Report Control1  
7.Report Control2  
8.Communiction  
v
0.00  
5. Select 3. Machine Control3and press the <YES> key.  
Machine Control3  
Declaration Compulsory  
Machine Control3  
Machine Control3  
Cash  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Rounding for commission calcu-  
lation  
^
on the receipt  
Print^  
Charge Declaration Compulsory  
Check Declaration Compulsory  
Credit Declaration Compulsory  
Receipt:Item consolidation  
Receipt:Sort by group  
Round off  
Print consecutive No.  
on the receipt  
Move two decimal place to  
right for unit prices  
Print consecutive No.  
on the receipt  
Print  
Print  
Print  
Print  
Print  
NO  
Print date on the receipt  
Print date on the journal  
Print time on the receipt  
Print time on the journal  
Vertical double size character  
for UP-350  
Print  
Receipt:Sort by department  
Receipt:Sort by group/dept  
with detail  
Print consecutive NO.  
on journal  
Print  
Print  
Print  
0P.ri0nt0v  
Total only  
Print date on the receipt  
Print date on the journal  
Print time on the receipt  
NO  
YES  
NO  
PRT RCT sort detail w/o TTL  
Commission total includes VAT  
NO  
NO  
Receipt auto cut  
E-Journal copy receipt  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Cash Declaration Compulsory: (not used)  
2. Charge Declaration Compulsory: (not used)  
3. Check Declaration Compulsory: (not used)  
4. Credit Declaration Compulsory: (not used)  
5. Receipt: Item Consolidation:  
Merge the same department/PLU registration on receipt.  
6. Receipt: Sort by group:  
Classify the registered items per group on receipt.  
7. Receipt: Sort by department:  
Classify the registered items per department on receipt.  
8. Receipt: Sort by group/dept with detail:  
You can choose Total onlyor With detail.”  
P-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-5-4 Programming the machine control 4  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
1.Machine Control1  
2.Machine Control2  
3.Machine Control3  
4.Machine Control4  
5.Print Control  
6.Report Control1  
7.Report Control2  
8.Communiction  
v
0.00  
5. Select 4. Machine Control4and press the <YES> key.  
Machine Control 4  
Drawer open alarm Min. 00-59  
Drawer open alarm Sec. 00-59  
Compulsory drawer control for  
0
0
multi drawers  
All drawers  
Update periodic at daily Z  
Scan link start record No.  
YES  
217  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
0.00  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Compulsory drawer control for multi drawers:  
You can choose All drawers/Drawers assigned to clerk.  
2. Scan link start record No.: The PLU items that are set after this record number are  
treated as scanning PLU items.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-5-5 Programming the print control  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
1.Machine Control1  
2.Machine Control2  
3.Machine Control3  
4.Machine Control4  
5.Print Control  
6.Report Control1  
7.Report Control2  
8.Communiction  
v
0.00  
5. Select 5. Print Controland press the <YES> key.  
Print Control  
Print Control  
Print Control  
Printing of total number of  
items sold on the receipt  
Print number of covers in  
header  
Set Menu Detail on Guest/Slip No Print  
Print Taxable Amount 9  
Print^  
Print  
Print PLU Number  
No Print  
Print  
Print  
Print  
Print  
Print  
Print  
Print  
Print  
Print Taxable Amount10  
Print Taxable Status  
No Print  
Print Finalized Total  
Print Taxable Amount1  
Print Taxable Amount2  
Print Taxable Amount3  
Print Taxable Amount4  
Print Taxable Amount5  
Print Taxable Amount6  
Print Taxable Amount7  
Print Taxable Amount8  
No Print  
Printing of total number of  
items sold on the receipt  
Print number of covers in  
header  
No Print  
NO  
No Print  
Cover print double size  
Print unit price on receipt  
One line feeded after  
finalization for receipt  
Time format 24/12Hour  
Single item without fin rct  
Always issue a receipt  
No Print  
No Print  
NO  
Cover print double size  
Print unit price on receipt  
One line feeded after  
finalization for receipt  
NO  
24 Hour  
NO  
No Print  
0P.ri0nt0v  
0.00  
NOv  
0.00  
NO  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
P-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-5-6 Programming the report control 1  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
1.Machine Control1  
2.Machine Control2  
3.Machine Control3  
4.Machine Control4  
5.Print Control  
6.Report Control1  
7.Report Control2  
8.Communiction  
v
0.00  
5. Select 6. Report Control1and press the <YES> key.  
Report Control1  
Report Control1  
Gross  
Net  
Print  
Print  
Number of covers  
No Print^  
No Print  
The average spend per cover  
Cash In Drawer  
Print  
Commission for Cashing A Check No Print  
Cash Declaration short/over  
Charge In Drawer  
No Print  
No Print  
Total Service charge  
Commission 1  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
Charge Declaration short/over No Print  
Commission 2  
Cheque In Drawer  
Print  
Foreign currency cash and  
Cheque in drawer totals  
Accumulate total of - key and  
%- key operation totals  
Accumulate total of RF key and  
Cheque Declaration short/over No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
Credit In Drawer  
Print  
Credit Declaration short/over No Print  
RF Mode total  
0P.ri0nt0v  
0.00  
v
Report Control1  
Report Control1  
VOID key operation totals  
No Print^  
No Print  
No Print  
Print  
TAXEX3  
TA4  
No Print^  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Printv  
Number of C key operations  
Rounding total  
TA1  
TAX4  
TAXEX4  
TA5  
TAX1  
Print  
TAXEX1  
TA2  
No Print  
Print  
TAX5  
TAXEX5  
TA6  
TAX2  
Print  
TAXEX2  
TA3  
No Print  
Print  
TAX6  
TAXEX6  
TA7  
TAX3  
0P.ri0nt0v  
0.00  
Report Control1  
TAX7  
No Print^  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
TAXEX7  
TA8  
TAX8  
TAXEX8  
TA9  
TAX9  
TAXEX9  
TA10  
TAX10  
TAXEX10  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
These items are included in the fixed totalizer report.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-5-7 Programming the report control 2  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
1.Machine Control1  
2.Machine Control2  
3.Machine Control3  
4.Machine Control4  
5.Print Control  
6.Report Control1  
7.Report Control2  
8.Communiction  
v
0.00  
5. Select 7. Report Control2and press the <YES> key.  
Report Control2  
Report Control2  
Report Control2  
Dept/Sub Dept Zero-Skip  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Printing of average spend per  
item on monthly report  
PLU Random Code Order  
PLU No. on X/Z Report  
Sales Ratio on X/Z Report  
Z Counter  
^
daily Fixed TTL report  
No Print^  
Print  
Print  
Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
NO  
Cashier/Clerk Zero-Skip  
Function Zero-Skip  
Print  
GT1(Daily)  
Mem Number  
No Print  
No Print  
Print  
GT2(Daily)  
PLU/Stock Zero-Skip  
GT3(Daily)  
Shift PLU Zero-Skip  
GT1(Periodic1&2)  
GT2(Periodic1&2)  
GT3(Periodic1&2)  
Display Flash  
Hourly Sales Zero-Skip  
Group Zero-Skip  
ITEM Discount Totalizer  
Double Z Report  
No Print  
NO  
Monthly Sales Zero-Skip  
Table Analysis Zero-Skip  
Hourly Production Zero-Skip  
Hourly Labor Zero-Skip  
X
VAT Recalculation on X/Z Report  
Stock Clear at Batch Z  
NO  
NO  
Display Employee Activity X  
NO  
Display Fixed Totalizer  
Display Dept/Sub Dept  
X
X
NO  
Print Consecutive No. range on  
v
NO  
0.Y0ES0v  
0.00  
0.00  
Report Control2  
Report Control2  
Report Control2  
Display Cashier/Clerk  
Display Function  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
NO^  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Display Fixed Totalizer  
Display Dept/Sub Dept  
Display Cashier/Clerk  
Display Function  
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
NO^  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NOv  
Display Cashier/Clerk  
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
NO^  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Display Function  
Display PLU/Stock  
Display Hourly/Monthly  
Display Group  
Display PLU/Stock  
Display Hourly/Monthly  
Display Group  
Display PLU/Stock  
Display Open Check  
Display Table Analysis  
Display E-Journal  
Display Hourly Product  
Display Employee  
Display Hourly/Monthly  
Display Group  
Display Open Check  
Display Table Analysis  
Display E-Journal  
Display Hourly Product  
Display Employee  
Display Open Check  
Display Table Analysis  
Display E-Journal  
Display Hourly Labor  
Display Hourly Product  
Display Hourly Labor  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Zero-Skip on Report:  
Skip zero total item.  
2. Print Monthly Sales Average:  
Print monthly sales average on monthly sales report.  
3. PLU random code order:  
You can choose Mem Number (by memory number)or Random Code.”  
4. VAT recaluculate on X/Z report:  
Calculate VAT amount at report issuance temporarily.  
5. Display Report:  
Show report on the LCD screen.  
P-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-5-8 Programming the communication  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
1.Machine Control1  
2.Machine Control2  
3.Machine Control3  
4.Machine Control4  
5.Print Control  
6.Report Control1  
7.Report Control2  
8.Communiction  
v
0.00  
5. Select 8. Communicationand press the <YES> key.  
Communication  
Copy program change to other  
terminals  
Communication  
sent to the master  
Own data file^  
NO  
Reset&Printing of consolida-  
tion file before reset report  
Master printing of consolida-  
tion reset report  
Retry INLINE X/Z Polling  
Allow to operate communication  
function  
YES  
Print  
Print  
YES  
Origin of reset data to be  
Reset consolidation total  
after inline consolidation  
Stock Result Copy  
sent to the master  
Own data file  
YES  
NO  
Reset&Printing of consolida-  
tion file before reset report  
Master printing of consolida-  
tion reset report  
Print  
Accumulation of data in consoli-  
dation area following RESET  
operation  
0P.ri0nt0v  
0.Y0ES0  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Copy program change to other terminals:  
Broadcast the programmed data in PGM 1 ~ 4 mode after completion of a program.  
2. Origin of reset data to be sent to the master:  
You can choose Own data fileor Consolidation file.”  
3. Stock result copy:  
Copy stock quantity to master daily file after Z consolidation.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-5-9 Programming the hourly sales  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
9.Hourly Sales  
^
v
10.SLIP / Guest  
11.Journal Control  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
16.Clerk Interrupt  
0.00  
5. Select 9. Hourly Salesand press the <YES> key.  
Hourly Sales  
Interval(Hours)  
1
0
0
0
Interval(Minutes)  
Start Time(Hour)  
Start Time(Minute)  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
0.00  
Field meaning  
1. Hour (00 ~ 23)  
2. Minute (00 ~ 59)  
4-1-5-10 Programming the slip/guest  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
9.Hourly Sales  
^
v
10.SLIP / Guest  
11.Journal Control  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
16.Clerk Interrupt  
0.00  
5. Select 10. SLIP/Guestand press the <YES> key.  
SLIP / Guest  
Print detail in order of Dept/  
Group on slip/Guest receipt  
SLIP / Guest  
SLIP / Guest  
^
Print additional items only  
Guest receipt  
NO^  
Entire memory  
Print detail in order of Dept/  
Group on slip/Guest receipt  
Total only  
NO  
Slip Auto Line Find  
Slip Maximum Lines  
NO  
0
PRT GUEST sort detail w/o TTL  
Consecutive No. on slip/Guest  
receipt  
Total only  
Maximum number of automatic  
line feed  
PRT GUEST sort detail w/o TTL  
Consecutive No. on slip/Guest  
receipt  
NO  
Print  
Print  
Print  
NO  
0
NO  
NO  
Print Date on slip/Guest RCT  
Print Time on slip/Guest RCT  
Back feed after slip Print  
Back feed after VLD Print  
Back feed after CHK-END/PRT  
Item consolidation on slip/  
Guest receipt  
Print  
Print  
Print  
NO  
Print Date on slip/Guest RCT  
Print Time on slip/Guest RCT  
Back feed after slip Print  
Back feed after VLD Print  
Printing only Group TTL on slip/  
Guest receipt  
NO  
NO  
Print only Dept TTL on Slip/  
v
NOv  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
P-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Field meaning  
1. Print additional items only:  
Slip printing begins with At the top of the transaction (Entire memory)/At the top of  
this receipt (Additional only).”  
2. Slip Maximum Line (00 ~ 99)  
Note: This line should be set.  
3. Back feed after slip Print/Back feed after VLD Print/Back feed after CHK-END/PRT:  
These lines are only effective for SP-1300.  
4-1-5-11 Programming the journal control  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
9.Hourly Sales  
^
10.SLIP / Guest  
11.Journal Control  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
16.Clerk Interrupt  
v
0.00  
5. Select 11. Journal Controland press the <YES> key.  
Journal Control  
Storage of TRG Operation into  
E-Journal  
YES  
NO  
Generate E-Journal full error  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Storage of TRG operation into electronic journal memory:  
Put training clerk registration data into electronic journal memory.  
2. Generate E-Journal full error:  
Alert when the electronic journal memory becomes full/Not alert even if the electronic  
journal memory becomes full..  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-5-12 Programming the message control  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
9.Hourly Sales  
^
10.SLIP / Guest  
11.Journal Control  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
16.Clerk Interrupt  
v
0.00  
5. Select 12. Message Controland press the <YES> key.  
Message Control  
Message Control  
Receipt Logo  
Message  
Print  
Receipt Commercial Message  
No Print^  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
Receipt Commercial Message  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
No Print  
Receipt Bottom  
Slip Commercial  
Slip Bottom  
Message  
Message  
Message  
Receipt Bottom  
Slip Commercial  
Slip Bottom  
Message  
Message  
Message  
Slip Intermediate Message  
Slip Intermediate Message  
Bill Top  
Message  
Message  
Bill Top  
Message  
Message  
Bill Copy  
Bill Copy  
Bill Bottom Message  
Receipt Logo either Graphic or  
Text  
Bill Bottom Message  
Receipt Logo either Graphic or  
Text  
Text  
Textv  
Report Header Print  
No Print  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Receipt Logo either graphic or text:  
Select Text Logo/Graphic Logo.  
4-1-5-13 Programming the order control  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
9.Hourly Sales  
^
v
10.SLIP / Guest  
11.Journal Control  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
16.Clerk Interrupt  
0.00  
5. Select 13. Order Controland press the <YES> key.  
Order Control  
Order Control  
Print location character  
Print Item Price  
No Print  
No Print  
Print dashed line  
NO^  
NO  
NO  
0
Print items on KP training  
operator  
Stop printing message on  
double BON  
No Print  
No Print  
NO  
Perform item consolidation on  
KP  
Print Detail of Set Menu  
Auto cutting every KP order  
Print dashed line  
Number of line feed before  
print dashed line or auto cut  
Number of line feed after  
print dashed line or auto cut  
Error generate Printer goes  
down  
NO  
Print items on KP training  
operator  
NO  
4
Perform item consolidation on  
KP  
NOv  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
P-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
4-1-5-14 Programming the set menu/condiment  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
9.Hourly Sales  
^
v
10.SLIP / Guest  
11.Journal Control  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
16.Clerk Interrupt  
0.00  
5. Select 14. Set Menu/Condimentand press the <YES> key.  
Set Menu/Condiment  
Calculate Price for detail  
Follow the same QTY as main  
YES  
item  
Fine Dining  
0
No. of Detail for Post Entry  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
0.00  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Calculate Price for detail:  
Calculate/Not calculate detail item prices in set menu.  
2. Follow the same QTY as main item:  
Fine Dining: Not allow to enter the number of the condiment, and follow the  
quantities of main PLU.  
Fast food: Allow to enter the number of the condiment, and not follow the  
quantities of main PLU.  
Fine Dining QTY: Not allow to enter the number of the condiment but allow to  
select the condiment by LIST staydown within the quantities of main  
PLU.  
3. No. of detail for Post Entry:  
The value of reserved record for post entry function in detail file.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-5-15 Programming the check tracking  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
9.Hourly Sales  
^
v
10.SLIP / Guest  
11.Journal Control  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
16.Clerk Interrupt  
0.00  
5. Select 15. CHK Trackingand press the <YES> key.  
CHK tracking  
CHK tracking  
Clearing CHK/TBL No. by using  
CHK is opened by OLD CHK key  
Perform item consolidation  
when CHK is opened by OLD CHK  
STORE/RECALL Start Range  
STORE/RECALL End Range  
Print^  
the same number again  
CHK Number  
NO  
CHK# 12 Digits(if No,6Digits)  
NO  
0
Tax Claculation print by after  
NB key  
NO  
0
Print previous balance when  
CHK is opened by OLD CHK key  
Perform item consolidation  
when CHK is opened by OLD CHK  
STORE/RECALL Start Range  
STORE/RECALL End Range  
Auto Check Start Range  
0
Print  
Auto Check End Range  
0
Reset STORE/RECALL No. after  
taking OPEN CHK Z report  
Suppress detail display  
SEP CHK Consolidation  
NO  
0
0.000v  
NO  
NO  
NO  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Clearing CHK/TBL No. by using the same number again:  
You can choose Check Numberor Table Number.  
4-1-5-16 Programming the clerk interrupt  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
9.Hourly Sales  
^
v
10.SLIP / Guest  
11.Journal Control  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
16.Clerk Interrupt  
0.00  
5. Select 16. Clerk Interruptand press the <YES> key.  
P-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clerk Interrupt  
Allow Clerk Interrupt  
NO  
Allow operation to clerks who  
are not allocated clerk  
interrupt detailed memory  
Auto Sign Off Timer for clerk  
interrupt (In seconds)  
NO  
0
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
0.00  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Clerk sign off timer: 0 - 99. (Sec.) This program is also effective for non-clerk interrupt  
system.  
4-1-5-17 Programming the display control  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
^
16.Clerk Interrupt  
17.Display Control  
18.Menu Shift 1  
19.Menu Shift 2  
0.00  
5. Select 17. Display Controland press the <YES> key.  
Display Control  
Backlight Off Timer(Min)  
1
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
0.00  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Backlight Off Timer: 0 - 59. (Minute)  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-5-18 Programming the menu shift 1  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
^
16.Clerk Interrupt  
17.Display Control  
18.Menu Shift 1  
19.Menu Shift 2  
0.00  
5. Select 18. Menu Shift 1and press the <YES> key.  
Menu Shift 1  
Menu Shift 1  
Menu Shift 1  
Accumulate 8th menu to (1)  
Destination(2) of accumulation  
for menu totalizing  
PLU  
Quantity Extension  
NO  
YES  
YES  
NO  
Accumulate 4th menu to (1)  
Accumulate 5th menu to (1)  
Accumulate 6th menu to (1)  
Accumulate 7th menu to (1)  
Accumulate 8th menu to (1)  
Destination(2) of accumulation  
for menu totalizing  
NO^  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO^  
DEPT  
Quantity Extension  
SUB DEPT Quantity Extension  
Accumulate touch PLU menus  
Follow menu total reset opera-  
tion to the destination  
0
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Accumulate 1st menu to (2)  
Accumulate 2nd menu to (2)  
Accumulate 3rd menu to (2)  
Accumulate 4th menu to (2)  
Accumulate 5th menu to (2)  
Accumulate 6th menu to (2)  
Accumulate 7th menu to (2)  
Accumulate 8th menu to (2)  
NO  
Destination(1) of accumulation  
for menu totalizing  
0
NO  
NO  
NO  
NOv  
0
NO  
NO  
Accumulate 1st menu to (2)  
Accumulate 2nd menu to (2)  
Accumulate 3rd menu to (2)  
Accumulate 4th menu to (2)  
Accumulate 1st menu to (1)  
Accumulate 2nd menu to (1)  
Accumulate 3rd menu to (1)  
NOv  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Accumulate touch PLU menus:  
Enable/Disable to sum up PLUs to one Menu sheet.  
2. Follow memu total reset operation to the destination:  
Reset child menu sheets with parent menu sheet together/Reset menu sheet indepen-  
dently.  
3. Destination of accumulation for menu totalizing:  
Define the sheet No. of parent menu sheet. (1 ~ 8)  
Note: Never use these functions with Shift PLU.  
P-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-5-19 Programming the menu shift 2  
Operation  
General Feature  
General Feature  
12.Message Control  
13.Order Control  
14.Set Menu/Condiment  
15.CHK Tracking  
^
16.Clerk Interrupt  
17.Display Control  
18.Menu Shift 1  
19.Menu Shift 2  
0.00  
5. Select 19. Menu Shift 2and press the <YES> key.  
Menu Shift 2  
Start PLU Number of 1st menu  
Start PLU Number of 2nd menu  
Start PLU Number of 3rd menu  
Start PLU Number of 4th menu  
Start PLU Number of 5th menu  
Start PLU Number of 6th menu  
Start PLU Number of 7th menu  
Start PLU Number of 8th menu  
1
109  
217  
325  
433  
541  
649  
757  
6. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
0.00  
7. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
Define start PLU No. of each menu sheet.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-6 Programming scheduler  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
1.Pulldown Group  
2.Set Menu Table  
3.Arrangement  
4.Batch X/Z  
5.General Feature  
6.Scheduler  
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
v
0.00  
4. Select 6. Schedulerand press the <YES> key.  
Scheduler D28 - D13  
D12 - D1  
0001-062 0000000000000000 000000000000  
0002-062 0000000000000000 000000000000  
0003-062 0000000000000000 000000000000  
0004-062 0000000000000000 000000000000  
0.00  
5. Enter schedule (refer to the next page) and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Description  
Scheduler start time (00:00 ~ 23:59)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D28 D27 D26 D25  
: : : :  
D24 D23 D22 D21  
Significant  
numbers  
Scheduler end time (00:00 ~ 23:59)  
;
D20  
Always 0”  
:
D19  
Significant  
number  
Interval control 1:  
Daily = 0, Weekly = 1, Monthly = 2  
Interval control 2:  
Daily; No meaning  
Weekly; Define day of a week  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
00; Sunday, 01; Monday, 02; Tuesday, 03; Wednesday,  
04; Thursday, 05; Friday, 06; Saturday  
Monthly; Define date, 01 ~ 31, 99 means the end of the month  
D18 D17  
: : : :  
Significant  
numbers  
Interval time (00:00 ~ 23:59)  
Always 0”  
D16 D15 D14 D13  
;
D12  
: : : :  
Significant  
numbers  
Arrangement table No.  
Arrangement file No.  
Always 0000”  
D11 D10 D9 D8  
: : :  
D7 D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-7 Programming check print  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
1.Pulldown Group  
2.Set Menu Table  
3.Arrangement  
4.Batch X/Z  
5.General Feature  
6.Scheduler  
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
v
0.00  
4. Select 7. Check Printand press the <YES> key.  
Check Print  
0001-041  
0002-041  
0003-041  
0004-041  
0005-041  
0006-041  
0007-041  
0008-041  
0009-041  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
0.00  
5. Enter value (below) and press the <YES> key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Define printing data:  
1; Printing amount  
3; Printing date  
5; Check endorsement message 1st line  
6; Check endorsement message 2nd line  
7; Check endorsement message 3rd line  
8; Check endorsement message 4th line  
2; Printing amount (double size)  
4; Printing date (double size)  
Significant  
number  
:
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
Feed before printing.  
Normal = 0  
Reverse = 2  
:
Feed direction  
(a+b+c)  
D4  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Feed 1 line after printing.  
No. of feed lines before printing (0 ~ 9)  
Printing offset digits (00 ~ 49)  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
P-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-8 Programming table analysis  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
1.Pulldown Group  
2.Set Menu Table  
3.Arrangement  
4.Batch X/Z  
5.General Feature  
6.Scheduler  
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
v
0.00  
4. Select 8. Table Analysisand press the <YES> key.  
Table Analysis  
TBL01  
TBL02  
TBL03  
TBL04  
TBL05  
TBL06  
TBL07  
TBL08  
TBL09  
TBL10  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
5. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES> key.  
6. Enter characters for table analysis and press the <YES> key.  
7. Enter value (below) and press the <YES> key.  
0.00  
8. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Note:  
This programming is only effective, if the check-# is 6-digit long  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Minimum check No. of the group  
(0means 1.)  
Significant  
numbers  
::::::  
D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7  
Maximum check No. of the group  
(000000means no programming.)  
Significant  
numbers  
::::::  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-9 Programming tax table  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
6.Scheduler  
^
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
9.Tax Table  
10.Void Table  
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection v  
0.00  
4. Select 9. Tax Tableand press the <YES> key.  
Tax Table  
Tax Table  
1.Tax Table  
2.Tax Table  
3.Tax Table  
4.Tax Table  
5.Tax Table  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(4)  
(5)  
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate table and press the <YES> key.  
Tax Table (1)  
Tax Rate(%)  
8.125  
Maximum Table Amount  
Rounding  
0.00  
Round Off  
Singapore Rounding  
Calculation Type  
Yes  
Add in(VAT)  
Sum of Cyclic Patterns  
No. of Cyclic Values  
Sum of Non-Cyclic Values  
Actual Values(01)  
Actual Values(02)  
Actual Values(03)  
0
0
0
0
0
0v  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES> key.  
7. Enter value (below) and press the <YES> key.  
8. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
0.00  
Field meaning  
1. Tax Rate(%): (VAT & VAT: Sharing rate for the primary taxable amount)  
Rate; 0.0001 ~ 9999.9999 % (Use Decimal point key)  
2. Maximum Table Amount:  
Maximum value; 0.00 ~ 9999.99  
3. Rounding:  
Selection; Cut off/Round off/Round up/Round up to two dp  
4. Singapore Rounding:  
Selection; Yes/No  
5. Calculation type:  
Selection;  
Not calculate/Table/Table & Add on/Add in (VAT)/Tax on Tax/VAT and VAT  
6. Sum of Cyclic Patterns, No. of Cyclic Values, Sum of Cyclic Values, Actual Values  
See the following pages.  
cf. VAT & VAT:  
1. Sharing rate of the primary taxable amount enter Tax ratefield.  
2. Actual tax table for primary tax table code enter Actual value (1)field.  
3. Actual tax table for secondary tax table code enter Actual value (2)field.  
P-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Explanation of U.S. tax table examples  
Tax table without a tax rate  
Max. break points  
Price Range  
Tax  
(6%)  
Differ-  
ence  
Pattern  
Upper  
Lower  
Min. break point Max. break point  
$
.01  
.11  
$
.10  
.24  
10  
24  
0
10  
24  
41  
58  
74  
91  
=
10  
14  
17  
17  
16  
17  
$.00  
.01  
.02  
.03  
.04  
.05  
.06  
.07  
Non-cyclic data  
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
.25  
.42  
.59  
.75  
.82  
1.09  
.41  
41  
.58  
58  
Cyclic data  
.74  
74  
.81  
91  
1.08  
1.24  
108  
124  
141  
17 Cyclic data  
108  
124  
16  
17  
Sum of a single cyclic pattern: 17 + 17 + 16 = 50  
Number of values in each cyclic pattern: 3  
Sum of values in the non-cyclic pattern: 10 + 14 = 24  
Non-cyclic values and one set of cyclic values (actual values): 10, 14, 17, 17, 16  
Tax system: Tax table without rate  
Tax table with a tax rate  
Max. break points  
Price Range  
Min. break point Max. break point  
Tax  
(6%)  
Differ-  
ence  
Pattern  
Upper  
Lower  
Non-cyclic data  
$
.01  
.08  
$
.07  
.21  
7
21  
0
7
=
7
14  
14  
14  
$.00  
.01  
.02  
.03  
.04  
.05  
.06  
.07  
.08  
.09  
.10  
.11  
.12  
.13  
.14  
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
.22  
.35  
35  
21  
35  
49  
64  
78  
92  
.36  
.49  
49  
.50  
.64  
64  
15 Cyclic data  
.65  
.78  
78  
14  
14  
15  
14  
14  
14  
.79  
.92  
92  
.93  
1.07  
1.21  
1.35  
1.49  
1.64  
1.78  
1.92  
2.07  
107  
121  
135  
149  
164  
178  
192  
207  
1.08  
1.22  
1.36  
1.50  
1.65  
1.79  
1.93  
107  
121  
135  
149  
164  
178  
192  
Cyclic data  
15  
14  
14  
15  
19.93  
20.07  
1.40  
On all sales above $20.07, compute the  
tax at a rate of 7%  
Sum of a single cyclic pattern: 14 + 14 + 14 + 15 + 14 + 14 + 15 = 100  
Number of values in each cyclic pattern: 7  
Sum of values in non-cyclic pattern: 7  
Sum of values in the non-cyclic pattern: 7  
Non-cyclic values and one set of cyclic values (actual values): 7, 14, 14, 14, 15, 14, 14, 15  
Maximum taxable amount in table calculation: $20.07  
Tax system: Tax table with rate  
Tax rate: 7.000%  
Rounding method: Cut off to two decimal places  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
Explanation of VAT & VAT  
Example 1: Share the amount  
Tax table programming  
Tax rate  
Calculation Primary Secondary  
(Share rate)  
type  
VAT  
VAT  
tax status tax status  
Table 1  
Table 2  
:
10.0000%  
20.0000%  
33.3333% for taxable 1  
66.6667% for taxable 2  
25.0000% for taxable 1  
75.0000% for taxable 2  
Table 4  
Table 5  
33.3333%  
25.0000%  
VAT & VAT  
VAT & VAT  
1
1
2
2
Item programming & registration result  
Program  
Registration result  
Unit price Tax status  
Taxable 1  
Taxable 2  
Item 1  
Item 2  
:
$10.00  
$20.00  
1
2
$10.00  
$20.00  
$10.00  
$20.00  
Item 4  
Item 5  
$30.00  
$40.00  
4
5
($30.00 × 33.3333%)  
($30.00 × 66.6667%)  
$10.00  
($40.00 × 25.0000%)  
$30.00  
($40.00 × 75.0000%)  
Example 2: The alternative of taxable 1 or 2  
Tax table programming  
Tax rate  
Calculation Primary Secondary  
(Share rate)  
type  
VAT  
VAT  
tax status tax status  
Table 1  
Table 2  
:
10.0000%  
20.0000%  
Table 4  
VAT & VAT  
1
2
Select tax status by <TAX EXEMPT>.  
Item programming & registration result  
Program  
Registration result  
Unit price Tax status  
Taxable 1  
Taxable 2  
Item 1  
$10.00  
4
$10.00  
$10.00  
Tax 1 Exempt  
$10.00  
Tax 2 Exempt  
$10.00  
P-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-10 Programming void table  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
6.Scheduler  
^
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
9.Tax Table  
10.Void Table  
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection v  
0.00  
4. Select 10. Void Tableand press the <YES> key.  
Void Table  
YES  
Use Void Table  
0.00  
5. Press the <YES> key.  
Void Table  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
000000  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES> key.  
7. Enter void character and press the <YES> key.  
8. Enter value (below) and press the <YES> key.  
9. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
0.00  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Return stock value.  
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-11 Programming system connection  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
6.Scheduler  
^
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
9.Tax Table  
10.Void Table  
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection v  
0.00  
4. Select 11. System Connectionand press the <YES> key.  
System Connection  
* 1 MC #01  
02010100000  
00000000000  
00000000000  
00000000000  
00000000000  
00000000000  
00000000000  
00000000000  
00000000000  
00000000000  
00000000000v  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
5. Select the record with *and press the <YES> key.  
6. Enter the logical ID character and press the <YES> key.  
8. Press the <Right arrow> key, enter value (below; D12,D11 and  
D10 ~ D1 ) and press the <YES> key.  
9
10  
11  
0.00  
9. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
10. This program should be made to all terminals in the cluster.  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
::::::  
D24 D23 D22 D21 D20 D19  
Significant  
characters  
Logical ID characters (within 12 characters)  
::::::  
D18 D17 D16 D15 D14 D13  
Terminal:  
Oneself = 02, Others = 01  
: :  
Significant  
numbers  
D12 D11  
Check tracking master/backup master (program value):  
Master = 01, Backup master = 02, Self master = 03, Satellite = 00  
: :  
Significant  
numbers  
D10 D9  
Check tracking master/backup master (current value):  
Master = 01, Backup master = 02, Self master = 03, Satellite = 00  
: :  
Significant  
numbers  
D8 D7  
; ; ; ; ;  
Always 00000”  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2  
Check tracking cluster No. (0 ~ 9)  
(0means no designation.)  
:
Significant  
number  
D1  
P-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-12 Programming I/O parameter  
Operation  
Note: Please perform the flag clear opera-  
tion of the terminal after changing the  
I/O parameter table.  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
6.Scheduler  
^
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
9.Tax Table  
10.Void Table  
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection v  
0.00  
4. Select 12. I/O Parameterand press the <YES> key.  
I/O Parameter  
0001-902  
0002-902  
0003-902  
0004-902  
0005-902  
0006-902  
0007-902  
0008-902  
0009-902  
0010-902  
0011-902  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate record, enter appropriate value (below)  
and press the <YES> key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
First record  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Inline baud rate:  
312kbps = 0*, 156kbps = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
* For INLINE 2 (CAT5) cable, select 312kbps only.  
Second record  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Online baud rate: 115200bps = 0,1  
57600bps = 2,  
9600bps = 5,  
Significant  
number  
:
38400bps = 3,  
4800bps = 6,  
19200bps = 4,  
2400bps = 7  
D2  
Activation signal (trigger):  
DR = 0, CI = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
Third record  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
;
Always 0”  
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
Note: Besides flag clear, please turn off and on  
the printer.  
Fourth record  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
No. of offset digits of slip/validation printing by SA-3015 (00 ~ 24)  
Always 000”  
D10D9  
; ; ;  
D8 D7 D6  
:
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Use SA-3015 printer for slip printing:  
D5  
Using RS-232C port for printer:  
COM4 = 0, COM5 = 5, COM6 = 6  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Baud rate of the RS-232C port for printer:  
19200bps = 0, 9600bps = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Using printer connected to RS-232C port: No printer = 99  
Significant  
numbers  
UP-350 = 00  
SA-3015 = 01  
UP-250 = 02  
: :  
D2 D1  
Note: Besides flag clear, please turn off and on  
the printer.  
Fifth record  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
No. of offset digits of slip/validation printing by SA-3015 (00 ~ 24)  
Always 000”  
D10D9  
; ; ;  
D8 D7 D6  
:
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Use SA-3015 printer for slip printing:  
D5  
Using RS-232C port for printer:  
COM5 = 0, COM4 = 4, COM6 = 6  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Baud rate of the RS-232C port for printer:  
19200bps = 0, 9600bps = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Using printer connected to RS-232C port: No printer = 99  
Significant  
numbers  
UP-350 = 00  
SA-3015 = 01  
UP-250 = 02  
: :  
D2 D1  
Sixth record  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Rear display:  
Connected * = 1, Not connected = 0  
Significant  
number  
:
D2  
Remote display:  
Connected * = 1, Not connected = 0  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
* You can connect either rear or remote display.  
Seventh record  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Display color:  
:
D1  
White line/black ground = 0, Black line/white ground = 1  
P-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Eighth record  
Description  
Description  
Choice  
Choice  
Program code  
;
Always 0”  
D1  
Nineth record  
Program code  
Parity:  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Even = 0, Non = 1, Odd = 2  
Bit:  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
7 bit = 0, 8 bit = 1  
Scanner:  
Connect = 2, No = 0  
Significant  
number  
:
D2  
Baud rate:  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
2400 bps = 0, 9600 bps = 1, 4800 bps = 2  
Tenth record  
Note: Besides flag clear, please turn off and on  
the printer.  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Using RS-232C port for printer:  
No printer = 0, COM2 = 2 (COM4 = 4, COM 5 = 5, COM 6 = 6)  
:
D4  
Significant  
number  
Baud rate of the RS-232C port for slip printer:  
No printer = 0, 9600bps = 1  
:
D3  
SP-1300:  
Connect = 70, No = 00  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D2 D1  
If you use COM 4 ~ 6, the automatic detection during INIT does not performed. Assign it manually.  
Eleventh record  
Note: Besides flag clear, please turn off and on  
the printer.  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D10D9  
No. of offset digits of slip/validation printing by SA-3015 (00 ~ 24)  
; ; ;  
D8 D7 D6  
Always 000”  
:
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Use SA-3015 printer for slip printing:  
Using RS-232C port for printer:  
COM6 = 0, COM4 = 4, COM5 = 5  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Baud rate of the RS-232C port for printer:  
19200bps = 0, 9600bps = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Using printer connected to RS-232C port: No printer = 99  
Significant  
numbers  
UP-350 = 00  
SA-3015 = 01  
UP-250 = 02  
: :  
D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-13 Programming printer connection  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
6.Scheduler  
^
7.Check Print  
8.Table Analysis  
9.Tax Table  
10.Void Table  
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection v  
0.00  
4. Select 13. Printer Connectionand press the <YES> key.  
Printer Connection  
1 R/J  
MC #01  
/1 MC #01  
/2 MC #01  
/1 MC #03  
/1 MC #03  
/2  
/1  
/2  
/1  
2 Report MC #02  
3 Order1 MC #03  
4 Order2 MC #01  
5 Order3  
6 Order4  
7 Order5  
8 Order6  
9 Order7  
10 No  
11 No  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate record of the main printer field and  
press the <YES> key.  
6. Select these options, 1.My Printer #1/2.My Printer #2/3.My  
Printer #3/4.RS-232C Printerand press the <YES> key.  
7. If you select 4.RS-232C Printer, select the terminal ID /1,  
/2 or /3.  
Backup printer definition field  
Main printer definition field  
Printer Connection  
Print  
1.No  
/1 stands for the specified printer which is programmed  
in the forth record. (page 68)  
/2 stands for the specified printer which is programmed  
in the fifth record. (page 68)  
/3 stands for the specified printer which is programmed  
in the eleventh record. (page 69)  
2.R/J  
3.Report  
4.Order1  
5.Order2  
6.Order3  
7.Order4  
8.Order5  
v
8. If you want to allocate backup printer, set the backup printer  
in the backup printer field.  
9. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
0.00  
0.00  
Printer Connection  
R/J  
Printer Connection  
RS-232C Printer  
1.MC #01  
2.MC #01  
3.MC #01  
4.MC #02  
5.MC #02  
6.MC #02  
7.  
/1  
/2  
/3  
/1  
/2  
/3  
1.My printer  
2.My printer  
3.My printer  
4.RS-232C Printer  
5.No  
/1  
/2  
/3  
8.  
v
0.00  
Note:  
The 10-th through 16-th record of this file are used for the printer definition of order ID  
change of the Manager function.  
The 17-th through 24-th record are not used.  
P-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-14 Programming time zone  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
9.Tax Table  
^
v
10.Void Table  
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection  
14.Time Zone  
15.Time & Attendance  
16.Hourly/Item Link  
0.00  
4. Select 14. Time Zoneand press the <YES> key.  
Time Zone  
0001-800  
0002-800  
0003-800  
0004-800  
0005-800  
0006-800  
.
Start  
09:00  
10:00  
15:00  
00:00  
00:00  
00:00  
End  
Cycle  
00:15  
00:30  
01:00  
00:00  
00:00  
00:00  
10:00  
12:00  
17:00  
00:00  
00:00  
00:00  
.
.
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate record, and enter the start time, end  
time, and cycle time.  
Cycle Time field  
End Time field  
Start Time field  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Rec-No. File No.  
Worksheet for time zone  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
: :  
D12 D11  
Zone Start Time (Hour)  
00 ~23  
: :  
Zone Start Time (Minute) (00~59)  
Zone End Time (Hour) (00~23)  
Zone End Time (Minute) (00~59)  
Zone Cycle (Hour) (00~23)  
00 ~ 59  
00 ~ 23  
D10 D9  
: :  
D8 D7  
: :  
D6 D5  
00 ~ 59  
: :  
D4 D3  
00 ~ 23  
: :  
D2 D1  
Zone Cycle (Minute) (00, 15, 30, 45)  
00, 15, 30, 45  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-15 Programming time & attendance  
Preparation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
9.Tax Table  
^
10.Void Table  
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection  
14.Time Zone  
15.Time & Attendance  
16.Hourly/Item Link v  
0.00  
4. Select 15. Time & Attendanceand press the <YES> key.  
4-1-15-1 Programming time & attendance (general)  
Operation  
Time & Attendance  
Time & Attendance  
1.General  
2.Job Code  
3.Employee&Scedule  
0.00  
5. Select 1. Generaland press the <YES> key.  
General  
Time & Attendance control  
Weekly work time  
Weekly  
40:00  
25:00  
NO  
Weekly work time for minor  
Work time includes break hours  
Rounding minute of work time  
Allow employee report Z with  
employees clocked-in  
Non  
NO  
Enable clerk to sign on after  
clock-in  
YES  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and choose options.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Field Meanings:  
1. Time&Attendance control:  
Weekly, Bi-weekly  
2. Rounding minute of work time:  
Non, 10 min., 15 min., 20 min., 30 min.  
P-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-15-2 Programming time & attendance (job code)  
Operation  
Time & Attendance  
Time & Attendance  
1.General  
2.Job Code  
3.Employee&Scedule  
0.00  
5. Select 2. Job Codeand press the <YES> key.  
Time & Attendance  
Job Code  
1.Cook  
2.Cashier  
3.Dish wash  
4.Floor cleaning  
5.JOB#05  
6.JOB#06  
7.JOB#07  
8.JOB#08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate job code and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No  
1
Descriptor  
Pay Rate  
Cook  
9999.99  
99.99  
NO  
Over Time Pay Ratio  
Tip Declaration Compulsory  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record to enter the character or number  
and press the <YES> key, or choose option.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-15-3 Programming time & attendance (employee & schedule)  
Operation  
Time & Attendance  
Time & Attendance  
1.General  
2.Job Code  
3.Employee&Scedule  
0.00  
5. Select 3. Employee&Scheduleand press the <YES> key.  
Time & Attendance  
Employee&Schedule  
1.Sean Harrison  
2.Oliver Clapton  
3.Richard Baker  
4.Geia Peabody  
5.Tyler Johnson  
6.EMP#06  
7.EMP#07  
8.EMP#08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate employee file, and press the <YES>  
key.  
Memory No  
1
Memory No  
1
Employee No.  
Descriptor  
123456  
Job Code(3)  
Job Code(4)  
Dish wash  
^
Sean Harrioson  
--------  
Social Security No.  
Job Code(1)  
1234567890  
Allow to Specify Job Code  
when Clocking-in  
Cook  
NO  
NO  
Job Code(2)  
Casier  
Allow to Clock-in with Non-  
Preset Job Code  
Job Code(3)  
Dish wash  
Job Code(4)  
--------  
NO  
Display Job Code Window  
when Clocking-in  
Allow to Specify Job Code  
when Clocking-in  
NO  
YES  
NO  
Minor Employee  
Allow to Clock-in with Non-  
Preset Job Code  
Ignore schedule setting  
NOv  
Cashier/Clerk Name  
Harrison  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record to enter the character or choose  
options.  
8. Press the <ESC> key to assign schedule mode.  
Field Meanings:  
Employee No.:  
Put in the numeric number (0 ~ 999999). When you put 0at the  
beginning of the number, these numbers are not recognized.  
Put the specific character within 16-digits from the leftmost side.  
Descriptor:  
Social Security No.: Put in the numeric number (0 ~ 9999999999). When you put 0”  
at the beginning of the number, these numbers are recognized.  
Job Code (1)~(4):  
Choose an item from the pulldown menu.  
Cashier/Clerk Name: Choose an employee from the character pulldow menu.  
P-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Time & Attendance  
Schedule  
1.Monday  
2.Tuesday  
3.Wednesday  
4.Thursday  
5.Friday  
6.Saturday  
7.Sunday  
0.00  
9. Select an appropriate day, and press the <YES> key.  
Sean Harrison  
Shift(1)  
Start Time  
Monday  
Cook  
08:00  
10:00  
00:15  
10  
End  
Time  
Break Time  
Grace Before Start  
Grace After Start  
Grace Before End  
Grace After End  
00  
00  
15  
Shift(2)  
Start Time  
End Time  
Waiter  
14:30  
17:00 v  
0.00  
10. Select an appropriate record to enter the appropriate job and  
time.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-16 Programming hourly item link  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
9.Tax Table  
^
10.Void Table  
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection  
14.Time Zone  
15.Time & Attendance  
16.Hourly/Item Link v  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
4. Select 16. Hourly/Item Linkand press the <YES> key.  
Hourly/Item Link  
Hourly/Item Link  
1.Time Zone  
2.Time Zone  
3.Time Zone  
4.Time Zone  
5.Time Zone  
6.Time Zone  
7.Time Zone  
8.Time Zone  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(4)  
(5)  
(6)  
(7)  
(8) v  
5. Select an appropriate record, and press the <YES> key.  
Time Zone  
(1)  
0001-031 0001-001 GROSS  
0002-031 0002-001 NET  
0003-031 0003-001 CAID  
0004-031 0007-001 CHID  
0005-031 0011-001 CKID  
0006-031 0015-001 CRID  
0007-031  
0008-031  
6. Selectanappropriaterecord, andchoosetheitemsfromPLU,  
subdepartment, department, function, fixed totalizer, group,  
and void reason.  
You can input the items directly from PLU, subdepartment,  
departmentandfreefunction. ThePLU#, S-DEPT#, DEPT#,  
and LIST# keys are possible to use.  
0009-031  
0010-031  
0011-031  
If you want to delete the item, move the cursor on an  
appropriate item, and then press the <NO> key. All items  
below the cursor will be deleted. If you press <YES>, the  
pulldown menu will appear to select an item.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to go to the next menu.  
P-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-17 Programming IDC link  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
10.Void Table  
^
11.System Connection  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection  
14.Time Zone  
15.Time & Attendance  
16.Hourly/Item Link  
17.IDC Link  
0.00  
4. Select 17. IDC Linkand press the <YES> key.  
IDC Link  
IDC Link  
1.IDC Link (0001)  
2.IDC Link (0002)  
3.IDC Link (0003)  
4.IDC Link (0004)  
5.IDC Link (0005)  
6.IDC Link (0006)  
7.IDC Link (0007)  
8.IDC Link (0008)  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate record, and press the <YES> key.  
IDC Link (0001)  
0001-804 0001-004 PLU0001  
Store File  
IDC(1)  
Store Data  
Whole Transaction  
6. Selectanappropriateitemandpressthe<YES>keytochoose  
an option.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
0.00  
Field Meanings:  
1. Item code:  
Choose an item from the pulldown menu of each file as below.  
PLU, Sub-Department, Department, Free Function, Pull Down Group  
Clerk  
If you choose Clerk, then whole transaction is stored regardless “Store Data”  
option.  
You can input the items directly from PLU, Subdepartment, Department and Free  
Function. The PLU#, S-DEPT#, DEPT#, and LIST# keys are possible to use.  
To clear the record, enter 0and then press the <YES> key.  
2. Store File:  
Specify the option for the Store File.  
No., IDC(1), IDC(2), IDC(3)  
3. Store Data:  
Specify the option for the store file.  
Item only, Whole Transaction  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-1-18 Programming Euro  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
11.System Connection ^  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection  
14.Time Zone  
15.Time & Attendance  
16.Hourly/Item Link  
17.IDC Link  
18.EURO (Sub Currency v  
0.00  
4. Select 18. EURO (sub currency and press the <YES> key.  
EURO (Sub Currency) Preset  
EURO (sub) addmode  
EURO (Sub Currency) Preset  
0
EURO(sub) Rate Rounding  
EURO(sub) > LOCAL(main) Rate  
LOCAL(main) Rate Rounding  
Print receipt EURO(sub) TL  
Print receipt EURO(sub) TAX  
Print receipt EURO(sub) Fin  
Print receipt EURO(sub) CG  
Print report EURO(sub) Amount  
EURO(sub) Drawer number  
Open drawer immediately  
Change is EURO(sub)  
Round off^  
Quit this menu if changed.  
LOCAL(main) > EURO(sub) Rate  
100  
0.01  
Round off  
EURO(sub) Rate Rounding  
Round off  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
0
EURO(sub) > LOCAL(main) Rate  
LOCAL(main) Rate Rounding  
Print receipt EURO(sub) TL  
Print receipt EURO(sub) TAX  
Print receipt EURO(sub) Fin  
Print receipt EURO(sub) CG  
Print report EURO(sub) Amount  
100  
Round off  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NOv  
0.00  
0.00  
5. Select the field you want to change and press the <YES>/  
<NO> key or enter the numeric value and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. After programming, you should press the <ESC> key to  
return to the previous menu.  
Field Meanings:  
1. EURO (sub) add mode:  
Monetary mode of the currency (0 ~ 3)  
Note: If you changed this value, just terminate this program and re-enter, in case of  
modifying some values in this menu.  
2. Rate: 6 digits, 0.00001 ~ 999999  
3. Rate rounding: Round off/Cut off/Round up  
4. Drawer number: Main = 0, 1/Sub (option) = 2  
P-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-1-19 Programming auto program control  
This program restricts the broadcasting feature after programming.  
Operation  
Machine Feature  
Machine Feature  
12.I/O Parameter  
13.Printer Connection  
14.Time Zone  
^
15.Time & Attendance  
16.Hourly/Item Link  
17.IDC Link  
18.EURO (Sub Currency  
19.Auto Pgm Control  
0.00  
4. Select 19. Auto Pgm controland press the <YES> key.  
Auto Pgm control  
0001-905  
0002-905  
0003-905  
0004-905  
0902 01  
0999 01  
0000 00  
0000 00  
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate record, and enter the program code.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Worksheet for Auto program control  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
File No.  
D6 D5 D4 D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Broadcast this file (designated by D6 ~ D3) only.  
Ignore to receive this file (designated by D6 ~ D3).  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2. Programming clerks  
Preparation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P3C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
2. Press <PGM MODE> to assign Program 3 mode.  
PGM-3  
1.Machine Feature  
2.Clerk  
3.Key Feature  
0.00  
3. Select 2. Clerkand press the <YES> key.  
4-2-1 Programming clerk features  
Operation  
Clerk  
Clerk  
1.Clerk Feature  
2.Operation  
3.Commission Rate  
4.Table Range  
5.Range  
6.Clerk Detail  
7.Clerk Key ID  
0.00  
4. Select 1. Clerk Featureand press the <YES> key.  
Clerk Feature  
Clerk Feature  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
8.  
7.C07  
08  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
P-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory No.  
Descriptor  
1
Memory No.  
1
C01  
Secret number  
1^  
0
Secret number  
1
Check No for Clerk Interrupt  
Drawer number  
Check No. for Clerk Interrupt  
Drawer number  
1
0
0
Type of operator  
Cashier  
Type of operator  
Cashier  
NO  
Treat as Trainee  
NO  
Treat as trainee  
Allow clerk to open check No.  
belonging to another clerks  
Prohibit clerk to sign on  
Clerk sign off when receipt is  
issued  
Allow clerk to open check No.  
belonging to another clerks  
Prohibit clerk to sign on  
Clerk sign off when receipt is  
issued  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
YES  
YESv  
0.00  
Void operation  
Curre0nt.o0nl0y  
6. Select an appropriate record and choose options.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Type of operator:  
Choose Cashier/Clerk/Manager.”  
2. Void operation:  
Choose Current only/Complete void/Not allowed.”  
3. Descriptor (16 digits)  
4. Secret code (1 ~ 9999)  
5. Check number for clerk interrupt (1 ~ 999999)  
6. Drawer number (1 ~ 2)  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-2 Programming operation  
Preparation  
Clerk  
Clerk  
1.Clerk Feature  
2.Operation  
3.Commission Rate  
4.Table Range  
5.Range  
6.Cashier Detail  
7.Clerk Key ID  
0.00  
4. Select 2. Operationand press the <YES> key.  
4-2-2-1 Programming clerk control  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift / 2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5v  
0.00  
5. Select 1. Clerk Controland press the <YES> key.  
Clerk Control  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
5.  
C
6.C06  
05  
7.  
8.C08  
07  
C
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Check No. Compulsory  
Table No. Compulsory  
No. of Covers Compulsory  
GST RCT Compulsory(Finalize)  
GST RCT Compulsory(NB)  
Slip Automatic Batch Print  
Compulsory(Finalize)  
SLIP Automatic Batch Print  
Compulsory(NB)  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Seat Number Compulsory  
Eat-in/Take-out Compulsory  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and choose options.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
P-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-2-2 Programming menu shift/2nd@  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5v  
0.00  
5. Select 2. Menu Shift/2nd@and press the <YES> key.  
Menu Shift / 2nd@  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
65..C06  
05  
C
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
1
Allow to operate 1st Menu  
Allow to operate 2nd Menu  
Allow to operate 3rd Menu  
Allow to operate 4th Menu  
Allow to operate 5th Menu  
Allow to operate 6th Menu  
Allow to operate 7th Menu  
Allow to operate 8th Menu  
Shift PLU after sign on  
Menu shift after sign on  
Price shift after sign on  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
0
Allow to operate 3rd Menu  
Allow to operate 4th Menu  
Allow to operate 5th Menu  
Allow to operate 6th Menu  
Allow to operate 7th Menu  
Allow to operate 8th Menu  
Shift PLU after sign on  
Menu shift after sign on  
Price shift after sign on  
Menu shift  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
0
0
0
0
Status  
0v  
Price shift  
Status  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and choose options.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Allow to operate 1st ~ 8th Menu:  
Allow/Prohibit to register by n-th (n = 1 ~ 8) Menu.  
2. Shift PLU after sign on: (1 ~ 8)  
Menu shift after sign on: (1 ~ 8)  
Price shift after sign on: (1 ~ 2)  
Default menu sheet No. or @ menu sheet No. after signing on.  
3. Menu shift status/stay down:  
Price shift status/stay down:  
Not maintain/Maintain menu sheet No./@ menu sheet No. after item registration.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-2-3 Programming mode control  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5v  
0.00  
5. Select 3. Mode Controland press the <YES> key.  
Mode Control  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
5.  
C
6.C06  
05  
7.  
8.C08  
07  
C
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
1
Allow to operate REG Mode  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Allow to operate PGM2 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM3 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM4 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM5 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM6 Mode  
Allow to operate X/Z Mode  
Allow to operate Manager Mode  
Allow to operate Inline Mode  
Allow to operate AutoPGM  
Allow to operate CF C0ard  
Default mode after sign on  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
REG  
Allow to operate RF  
Mode  
Allow to operate REG- Mode  
Allow to operate PGM1 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM2 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM3 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM4 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM5 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM6 Mode  
Allow to operate X/Z Mode  
Allow to operate Manager Mode  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and choose options.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Allow to operate Auto PGM (inline):  
Allow to download/upload program.  
P-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-2-4 Programming function control 1  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5v  
0.00  
5. Select 4. Allowed function 1and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed Function 1  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
5.  
C
6.C06  
05  
7.  
8.C08  
07  
C
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
Cash  
1
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
1
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Table Transfer  
Tip  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Received on Account  
Paid Out  
Pick Up  
Coupon  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Charge  
Check  
Normal Receipt  
Loan  
Credit  
New Balance  
Price Inquiry  
Stock Inquiry  
Received on Account  
Paid Out  
Pick Up  
Deposit  
Minus  
% Minus  
Plus  
Operate Character Recall  
Character Print  
Check Print  
Coupon  
Deposit  
% Plus  
Minus  
Refund  
Clerk Transfer  
YESv  
% Minus  
Coupon2  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-2-5 Programming function control 2  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5v  
0.00  
5. Select 5. Allowed function 2and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed Function 2  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
65..C06  
05  
C
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
Validation  
Receipt  
1
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
1
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
SLIP Back Feed/Release  
SLIP Print  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
SLIP Feed/Release  
T/S  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Check Endorsement  
#
SLIP Feed/Release  
T/S  
Table Number  
Money Declaration  
Tax Exempt  
#/Non Sales  
Non Sales  
Table Number  
Money Declaration (not used)  
Tax Exempt  
Menu Shift  
Number of Covers  
Arrangement  
Currency Exchange  
VAT  
Shift PLU  
Menu Shift  
LC Open  
Shift PLU  
Preset Open  
LC Open  
1st unit price shift  
2nd unit price shift  
Bill Copy  
Preset Open  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
P-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-2-6 Programming function control 3  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5v  
0.00  
5. Select 6. Allowed function 3and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed Function 3  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
65..C06  
05  
C
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
X
1
Operator X/Z  
Tray Total  
Subtotal  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
X/For  
X/XX  
Receipt on/off  
X/XXX  
TAST  
Ketten Bon  
Operator Number  
Selective Item ST  
New Check  
MDST  
X
Old Check  
X/For  
X/XX  
X/XXX  
New/Old Check  
Add Check  
Separate Check  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-2-7 Programming function control 4  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5v  
0.00  
5. Select 7. Allowed function 4and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed Function 4  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
65..C06  
05  
C
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
Substitution  
House Bon  
1
Memory No.  
1
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Eat-in  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Take-out  
Store  
Operator Open Check  
Media Change  
Seat Number  
Display On/Off  
REG Mode  
Recall  
Dutch Account  
Reverse Display  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
E-Journal Display  
Home Position  
X/Z Mode  
PGM Mode  
Display Mode Change  
All Void (Current only)  
All Void (Complete Void)  
Post Entry  
Round Repeat  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
P-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-2-8 Programming function control 5  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5v  
0.00  
5. Select 8. Allowed function 5and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed Function 5  
Clerk Feature  
1.C01  
2.C02  
3.C03  
4.C04  
5.C05  
6.C06  
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Record No.  
1
Price  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
PLU Number  
Sub Department Number  
Department Number  
List Number  
Touch PLU  
Touch Department  
Touch Sub Department  
Touch List  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-2-9 Programming arrangement control  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
3.Mode Control  
^
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5  
9.Arrangement  
10.Report  
0.00  
5. Select 9. Arrangementand press the <YES> key.  
Arrangement  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
65..C06  
05  
C
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
ARG GP(1) Opration  
ARG GP(2) Opration  
ARG GP(3) Opration  
ARG GP(4) Opration  
ARG GP(5) Opration  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
P-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-2-10 Programming X/Z report control  
Operation  
Operation  
Operation  
3.Mode Control  
^
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5  
9.Arrangement  
10.Report  
0.00  
5. Select 10. Reportand press the <YES> key.  
Report  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
65..C06  
05  
C
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
1
Daily X  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Batch X/Z(6)  
Batch X/Z(7)  
Batch X/Z(8)  
Batch X/Z(9)  
Batch X/Z(10)  
Operator X  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Batch X/Z(7)  
Batch X/Z(8)  
Batch X/Z(9)  
Batch X/Z(10)  
Operator X  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Daily Z  
Periodic(1) X  
Periodic(1) Z  
Periodic(2) X  
Periodic(2) Z  
Batch X/Z(1)  
Batch X/Z(2)  
Batch X/Z(3)  
Batch X/Z(4)  
Batch X/Z(5)  
Operator Z  
Operator Z  
Individual totalizer X/Z  
Individual X/Z (Key direct)  
Individual X/Z (Others)  
Employee X/Z  
Individual totalizer X/Z  
Individual X/Z (Key direct)  
Individual X/Z (Others)  
Employee X/Z  
Employee Edit  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-3 Programming commission rate  
Operation  
Clerk  
Clerk  
1.Clerk Feature  
2.Operation  
3.Commission Rate  
4.Table Range  
5.Range  
6.Cashier Detail  
7.Clerk Key ID  
0.00  
4. Select 3. Commission Rateand press the <YES> key.  
Commission Rate  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
65..C06  
05  
C
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Commission Rate(1)  
Commission Rate(2)  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and enter value (0 ~ 99.99), and  
then press the <YES> key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
P-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-4 Programming table range  
Operation  
Clerk  
Clerk  
1.Clerk Feature  
2.Operation  
3.Commission Rate  
4.Table Range  
5.Range  
6.Cashier Detail  
7.Clerk Key ID  
0.00  
4. Select 4. Table Rangeand press the <YES> key.  
Table Range  
1.  
2.C02Clerk Feature  
01  
C
3.  
4.C04  
03  
C
65..C06  
05  
C
7.C07  
8.C08  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate clerk and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Start Table Range  
End Table Range  
0
0
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate record and enter values (0 ~ 999999),  
and then press the <YES> key.  
8. After programming, press the <ESC> key to return to the  
previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-5 Programming clerk by range  
Preparation  
Clerk  
Clerk  
1.Clerk Feature  
2.Operation  
3.Commission Rate  
4.Table Range  
5.Range  
6.Cashier Detail  
7.Clerk Key ID  
0.00  
4. Select 5. Rangeand press the <YES> key.  
4-2-5-1 Programming clerk control by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift / 2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5 v  
0.00  
5. Select 1. Clerk Controland press the <YES> key.  
Clerk Control  
Check No. Compulsory  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Table No. Compulsory  
No. of Covers Compulsory  
GST RCT Compulsory(Finalize)  
GST RCT Compulsory(NB)  
Slip Automatic Batch Print  
Compulsory(Finalize)  
SLIP Automatic Batch Print  
Compulsory(NB)  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Seat Number Compulsory  
Eat-in/Take-out  
6. Select an appropriate record and choose options.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
0.00  
Clerk Control  
Clerk Control  
Enter Start range  
0
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
End  
range  
123  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-5-2 Programming menu shift/2nd@ by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5 v  
0.00  
5. Select 2. Menu Shift / 2nd@and press the <YES> key.  
Menu Shift / 2nd@  
Allow to operate 1st Menu  
Allow to operate 2nd Menu  
Allow to operate 3rd Menu  
Allow to operate 4th Menu  
Allow to operate 5th Menu  
Allow to operate 6th Menu  
Allow to operate 7th Menu  
Allow to operate 8th Menu  
Shift PLU after sign on  
Menu shift after sign on  
Price shift after sign on  
Menu Shift / 2nd@  
Allow to operate 3rd Menu  
Allow to operate 4th Menu  
Allow to operate 5th Menu  
Allow to operate 6th Menu  
Allow to operate 7th Menu  
Allow to operate 8th Menu  
Shift PLU after sign on  
Menu shift after sign on  
Price shift after sign on  
Menu shift  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
0
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
0
0
0
0
Status  
0v  
Price shift  
Status  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and choose options.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Menu Shift / 2nd@  
Enter Start range  
Menu Shift / 2nd@  
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
End  
range  
0
99  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-5-3 Programming mode control by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5 v  
0.00  
5. Select 3. Mode Controland press the <YES> key.  
Mode Control  
Mode Control  
Allow to operate PGM2 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM3 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM4 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM5 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM6 Mode  
Allow to operate X/Z Mode  
Allow to operate Manager Mode  
Allow to operate Inline Mode  
Allow to operate AutoPGM  
Allow to operate CF Card  
Default mode after sign on  
Allow to operate REG Mode  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
REG  
Allow to operate RF  
Mode  
Allow to operate REG- Mode  
Allow to operate PGM1 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM2 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM3 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM4 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM5 Mode  
Allow to operate PGM6 Mode  
Allow to operate X/Z Mode  
Allow to operate Manager Mode  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and choose options.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Mode Control  
Mode Control  
Enter Start range  
0
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
End  
range  
99  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-5-4 Programming function control 1 by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5 v  
0.00  
5. Select 4. Allowed function 1and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed function 1  
Allowed function 1  
Allowed function 1  
Cash  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Table Transfer  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Received on Account  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Charge  
Check  
Credit  
Tip  
Paid Out  
Pick Up  
Coupon  
Deposit  
Minus  
Normal Receipt  
Loan  
New Balance  
Received on Account  
Paid Out  
Pick Up  
Price Inquiry  
Stock Inquiry  
% Minus  
Plus  
Operate Character Recall  
Character Print  
Check Print  
Coupon  
Deposit  
% Plus  
Refund  
Coupon2  
Minus  
Clerk Transfer  
% Minus  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Allowed function 1  
Allowed function 1  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
0
99  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-5-5 Programming function control 2 by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5 v  
0.00  
5. Select 5. Allowed function 2and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed function 2  
Allowed function 2  
Allowed function 2  
Validation  
Receipt  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
SLIP Back Feed/Release  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
T/S  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
SLIP Print  
SLIP Feed/Release  
T/S  
Table Number  
Money Declaration  
Tax Exempt  
Check Endorsement  
#
#/Non Sales  
Non Sales  
Table Number  
Money Declaration  
Tax Exempt  
Menu Shift  
Shift PLU  
Menu Shift  
Shift PLU  
Number of Covers  
Arrangement  
Currency Exchange  
VAT  
LC Open  
Preset Open  
1st unit price shift  
2nd unit price shift  
Clerk Number  
LC Open  
Bill Copy  
Preset Open  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Allowed function 2  
Allowed function 2  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
123  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-5-6 Programming function control 3 by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5 v  
0.00  
5. Select 6. Allowed function 3and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed function 3  
Allowed function 3  
Operator X/Z  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
X/XX  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Tray Total  
Subtotal  
Receipt on/off  
TAST  
X/XXX  
Ketten Bon  
Selective Item ST  
New Check  
Operator Number  
MDST  
Old Check  
New/Old Check  
Add Check  
X
X/For  
Separate Check  
Clock-in/out  
Break-in/out  
X/XX  
X/XXX  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Allowed function 3  
Allowed function 3  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
123  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-5-7 Programming function control 4 by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5 v  
0.00  
5. Select 7. Allowed function 4and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed function 4  
Allowed function 4  
Substitution  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Eat-in  
Take-out  
Store  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
House Bon  
Operator Open Check  
Media Change  
Seat Number  
Display On/Off  
REG Mode  
Recall  
Dutch Account  
Reverse Display  
E-Journal Display  
Home Position  
X/Z Mode  
PGM Mode  
Display Mode Change  
All Void (Current only)  
All Void (Complete Void)  
0.00  
Post Entry  
Round Repeat  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Allowed function 4  
Allowed function 4  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
0
123  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-5-8 Programming function control 5 by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
1.Clerk Control  
2.Menu Shift/2nd@  
3.Mode Control  
4.Allowed function 1  
5.Allowed function 2  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5 v  
0.00  
5. Select 8. Allowed function 5and press the <YES> key.  
Allowed function 5  
Price  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
PLU Number  
Sub Department Number  
Department Number  
List Number  
Touch PLU  
Touch Department  
Touch Sub Department  
Touch List  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Allowed function 5  
Allowed function 5  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
123  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-5-9 Programming arrangement control by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
5.Allowed function 2^  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5  
9.Arrangement  
10.Report  
11.Commission Rate  
12.Table Range  
0.00  
5. Select 9. Arrangementand press the <YES> key.  
Arrangement  
ARG GP(1) Opration  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
ARG GP(2) Opration  
ARG GP(3) Opration  
ARG GP(4) Opration  
ARG GP(5) Opration  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Arrangement  
Arrangement  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
123  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-5-10 Programming X/Z report control by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
5.Allowed function 2^  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5  
9.Arrangement  
10.Report  
11.Commission Rate  
12.Table Range  
0.00  
5. Select 10. Reportand press the <YES> key.  
Report  
Report  
Report  
Daily X  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Batch X/Z(6)  
Batch X/Z(7)  
Batch X/Z(8)  
Batch X/Z(9)  
Batch X/Z(10)  
Operator X  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YESv  
Batch X/Z(7)  
Batch X/Z(8)  
Batch X/Z(9)  
Batch X/Z(10)  
Operator X  
YES^  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
Daily Z  
Periodic(1) X  
Periodic(1) Z  
Periodic(2) X  
Periodic(2) Z  
Batch X/Z(1)  
Batch X/Z(2)  
Batch X/Z(3)  
Batch X/Z(4)  
Batch X/Z(5)  
Operator Z  
Operator Z  
Individual totalizer X/Z  
Individual X/Z (Key direct)  
Individual X/Z (Others)  
Employee X/Z  
Individual totalizer X/Z  
Individual X/Z (Key direct)  
Individual X/Z (Others)  
Employee X/Z  
Employee Edit  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record and press the <YES>/<NO>  
key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Report  
Report  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
0
123  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-5-11 Programming commission rate by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
5.Allowed function 2^  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5  
9.Arrangement  
10.Report  
11.Commission Rate  
12.Table Range  
0.00  
5. Select 11. Commission Rateand press the <YES> key.  
Commission Rate  
Commission Rate(1)  
Commission Rate(2)  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record, enter the rate and press the  
<YES> key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Commission Rate  
Commission Rate  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
123  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2-5-12 Programming table range by range  
Operation  
Range  
Operation  
5.Allowed function 2^  
6.Allowed function 3  
7.Allowed function 4  
8.Allowed function 5  
9.Arrangement  
10.Report  
11.Commission Rate  
12.Table Range  
0.00  
5. Select 12. Table Rangeand press the <YES> key.  
Table Range  
Start Table Range  
End Table Range  
0
0
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate record, enter the range and press the  
<YES> key.  
7. After programming, press the <ESC> key to proceed to the  
next step.  
Table Range  
Table Range  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
99  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
0.00  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-2-6 Programming clerk detail  
Operation  
Clerk  
Clerk  
1.Clerk Feature  
2.Operation  
3.Commission Rate  
4.Table Range  
5.Range  
6.Clerk Detail  
7.Clerk Key ID  
0.00  
4. Select 6. Clerk Detailand press the <YES> key.  
Addition/Modification  
Clerk Detail  
0001-030 0001-001 GROSS  
0002-030 0002-001 NET  
0003-030 0003-001 CAID  
0004-030 0001-006 GRP001  
0005-030 0005-006 PLU001  
0006-030 0001-002 CASH  
0007-030  
0008-030  
0009-030  
0010-030  
0.00  
7. Selectarecordyouwanttoaddanitemormodifytheitemand  
press the <YES> key.  
Clerk Detail  
Item  
1.Fixed Totalizer  
2.Free Function  
3.PLU  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Dept  
6.Group  
7.Void Table  
0.00  
8. Select a file which you want to program.  
Clerk Detail  
Fixed Totalizer  
1.GROSS  
2.NET  
3.CAID  
4.CATL  
5.CA+  
6.CA-  
7.CHID  
8.CHTL  
v
0.00  
9. Select a record which you want to program.  
10. Repeat step 7 to 9, until completing this pulldown group item  
program.  
11. Press <ESC> key to terminate the program and return to the  
previous menu.  
P-106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deletion  
Clerk Detail  
0001-030 0001-001 GROSS  
0002-030 0002-001 NET  
0003-030 0003-001 CAID  
0004-030 0001-006 GRP001  
0005-030 0005-006 PLU001  
0006-030 0001-002 CASH  
0007-030  
0008-030  
0009-030  
0010-030  
0.00  
6. Select the smallest record you want to delete the item(s) and  
press the <NO> key.  
Clerk Detail  
Memory No. 01-10 Delete OK? Yes  
0.00  
7. Press the <YES> key.  
8. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
4-2-7 Programming clerk key ID  
Operation  
Clerk  
Clerk  
1.Clerk Feature  
2.Operation  
3.Commission Rate  
4.Table Range  
5.Range  
6.Cashier Detail  
7.Clerk Key ID  
0.00  
4. Select 7. Clerk Key IDand press the <YES> key.  
Clerk Key ID  
1234567890AB  
ABCDEFGHIJKL  
Clerk Key CID  
01  
GLENN DEAL  
Clerk  
1.(Key ID reset)  
2.  
C01  
3.GLENN DEAL  
4.C  
5.C  
6.C  
C
03  
04  
05  
8.  
7.C06  
07  
v
0.00  
0.00  
5. Contact the clerk key to the clerk key switch, and press the  
<YES> key.  
6. Select the appropriate clerk.  
7. Repeat step 5 to 6, until completing this procedure.  
8. Press <ESC> key to terminate the program and return to the  
previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3. Programming key features  
Preparation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P3C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
2. Press <PGM MODE> to assign Program 3 mode.  
PGM-3  
1.Machine Feature  
2.Clerk  
3.Key Feature  
0.00  
3. Select 3. Key Featureand press the <YES> key.  
4-3-1 Programming PLU features  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
v
0.00  
4. Select 1.PLUand press the <YES> key.  
Key Feature  
PLU  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate item directly, by entering record No. or  
by entering PLU No. and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Record No.  
Order color  
1
Use Random Code  
Descriptor  
123456  
Black^  
PLU0001  
Order Printer #1  
Order Printer #2  
Order Printer #3  
Order Printer #4  
Order Printer #5  
Order Printer #6  
Order Printer #7  
Order char Link  
Number of Bon  
NO  
Price  
0.00  
Normal Item  
Normal Item  
--------  
--------  
--------  
Non Tax  
NO  
Receipt type  
Item type  
NO  
NO  
Group Link  
Dept Link  
NO  
NO  
Sub-Dept Link  
Taxable status  
Commission  
NO  
--------  
0
None  
Selective item  
Nonev  
Unit stock  
0.000v  
0.00  
0.00  
P-108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
List Link #4  
Open PLU  
1
Minimum Stock  
Set Menu Table  
List Link #1  
List Link #2  
List Link #3  
List Link #4  
Open PLU  
0.000^  
0
--------^  
NO  
--------  
--------  
--------  
--------  
NO  
Zero Unit Price  
Negative Price  
NO  
NO  
Hash Item  
NO  
Full hash item  
NO  
High Amount Limit  
Low Digit Limit  
Multiple VLD  
0.00  
Zero Unit Price  
Negative Price  
Hash Item  
NO  
0
N Repeat  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Use main Item Amt Only  
Use Premium Item of Set  
Full hash item  
NOv  
NO  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Selectanappropriaterecordandpressthe<YES>/<NO>key  
or enter the numeric value and press the <YES> key.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Receipt type:  
You can choose Normal Itemor Single Item.”  
2. Item type:  
You can choose Normal item, Condimentor Preparation.”  
3. Order color:  
You can choose Blackor Red. (for UP-350, Blackmeans Normaland Red”  
Reverse.  
4. Order Printer #1 ~ #7:  
These numbers are defined in the printer definition table  
5. Random code: 000001 - 999999, Descriptor: 0-24 character, Number of Bon: 1 - 9,  
Minimum stock: 0.001 - 99.999, Unit stock: 0.001 - 99.999,  
High amount limit: 0 - 999999, Low digit limit: 0, 1 - 7  
Note:  
Ifyouwanttodeletetheprograminthegrouplink,deptlink,sub-deptlink,listlinkfield,order  
character link, enter 0and press the <YES> key.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-2 Programming PLU 2nd@ features  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
v
0.00  
4. Select 2. PLU 2nd@and press the <YES> key.  
Key Feature  
PLU 2nd@  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate item directly, by entering record No. or  
by entering PLU No. and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
Random Code  
0
Descriptor  
Qty  
PLU0001  
0.00  
0.00  
Price  
Group Link  
Dept Link  
Sub-Dept Link  
--------  
--------  
--------  
Non Tax  
0.000  
Taxable status  
Unit Stock  
Zero Unit Price  
NO  
0.00  
6. Selectanappropriaterecordandpressthe<YES>/<NO>key  
or enter the numeric value and press the <YES> key.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Qty: 0.00 - 9999.99, Descriptor: 0 - 24 character, Price: 0 - 999999,  
Unit stock: 0.001 - 99.999  
P-110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-3 Programming subdepartment features  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
v
0.00  
4. Select 3. Sub-Departmentand press the <YES> key.  
Key Feature  
Sub-Department  
1.SUBDEPT01  
2.SUBDEPT02  
3.SUBDEPT03  
4.SUBDEPT04  
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate item directly or by entering record No.  
and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
Descriptor  
Price  
1
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
1
SUBDEPT01  
Order Printer #3  
Order Printer #4  
Order Printer #5  
Order Printer #6  
Order Printer #7  
Order Char Link  
Number of Bon  
List Link #1  
NO^  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
List Link #1  
List Link #2  
List Link #3  
List Link #4  
--------^  
0.00  
--------  
Receipt Type  
Group Link  
Dept Link  
Normal Item  
--------  
--------  
Non Tax  
None  
--------  
--------  
Zero Unit Price  
Negative Price  
Hash Item  
NO  
NO  
Taxable status  
Commission  
Selective item  
Order color  
--------  
0
--------  
--------  
--------  
-0--.--0--0-v  
NO  
None  
Full hash item  
High Amount Limit  
Low Digit Limit  
Multiple VLD  
NO  
Black  
List Link #2  
0.00  
0
Order Printer #1  
Order Printer #2  
NO  
List Link #3  
NOv  
List Link #4  
0.00  
N0R.ep0ea0t  
6. Selectanappropriaterecordandpressthe<YES>/<NO>key  
or enter the numeric value and press the <YES> key.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Descriptor: 0 - 24 character, Price: 0 - 999999, Number of Bon: 1 - 9,  
High amount limit: 0 - 999999, Low digit limit: 0, 1 - 7  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-4 Programming department features  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
v
0.00  
4. Select 4. Departmentand press the <YES> key.  
Key Feature  
Department  
1.DEPT01  
2.DEPT02  
3.DEPT03  
4.DEPT04  
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate item directly or by entering record No.  
and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
Descriptor  
Price  
1
Memory No.  
1
Memory No.  
1
DEPT01  
Order Printer #4  
Order Printer #5  
Order Printer #6  
Order Printer #7  
Order Char Link  
Number of Bon  
List Link #1  
NO^  
NO  
List Link #1  
List Link #2  
List Link #3  
List Link #4  
--------^  
0.00  
--------  
Receipt Type  
Group Link  
Taxable status  
Commission  
Selective item  
Order color  
Normal Item  
--------  
Non Tax  
None  
NO  
--------  
NO  
--------  
--------  
Zero Unit Price  
Negative Price  
Hash Item  
NO  
NO  
0
--------  
--------  
--------  
--------  
None  
NO  
Black  
NO  
List Link #1  
Full hash item  
High Amount Limit  
Low Digit Limit  
Multiple VLD  
NO  
Order Printer #1  
Order Printer #2  
Order Printer #3  
List Link #1  
0.00  
0
NO  
List Link #1  
NOv  
Zero Unit Price  
NOv  
0.00  
0.00  
N0R.ep0ea0t  
6. Selectanappropriaterecordandpressthe<YES>/<NO>key  
or enter the numeric value and press the <YES> key.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Field meaning  
1. Descriptor: 0 - 24 character, Price: 0 - 999999, Number of Bon: 1 - 9,  
High amount limit: 0 - 999999, Low digit limit: 0, 1 - 7  
P-112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-5 Programming by range  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
v
0.00  
4. Select 5. Rangeand press the <YES> key.  
Select the subject you want to program  
Range  
Range  
Range  
Range  
1.PLU  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Deparment  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Deparment  
0.00  
0.00  
Range  
Range  
Range  
1.PLU  
Range  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Deparment  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Deparment  
0.00  
0.00  
5. Select  
1. PLU/2. PLU 2nd@/3. Sub-Department/4. Department”  
and press the <YES> key.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-5-1 General procedure of PLU, PLU 2nd@, subdepartment, department by range  
PLU  
Range  
1.Receipt type  
2.Item Type  
3.Group Link  
4.Dept Link  
5.Sub-Dept link  
6.Taxable status  
7.Commission  
8.Selective item  
v
0.00  
6. Selectanappropriatejob(refertothenextpage) andpressthe  
<YES> key.  
Receipt Type  
Receipt Type  
Normal Item  
Enter Start range  
0
0
End  
range  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
7. Select an appropriate type and press the <YES> key.  
Receipt Type  
Receipt Type  
Normal Item  
Enter Start range  
1
0
End  
range  
OK?  
YES  
8. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.)  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
0.00  
Receipt Type  
Receipt Type  
Normal Item  
Enter Start range  
End range  
1
50  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
9. Press the <YES> key.  
10. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-5-2 Programming hierarchy of programming title  
PLU  
PLU 2nd@  
Sub-Dept  
Dept  
1. Receipt Type  
2. Item Type  
1. Receipt Type  
1. Receipt Type  
3. Group Link  
4. Dept Link  
1. Group Link  
2. Dept Link  
2. Group Link  
3. Dept Link  
2. Group Link  
5. Sub-Dept Link  
6. Taxable Status  
7. Commission  
3. Sub-Dept Link  
4. Taxable Status  
4. Taxable Status  
5. Commission  
3. Taxable Status  
4. Commission  
8. Selective item  
9. Order color  
6. Selective item  
7. Order color  
5. Selective item  
6. Order color  
10. Order Printer #1  
11. Order Printer #2  
12. Order Printer #3  
13. Order Printer #4  
14. Order Printer #5  
15. Order Printer #6  
16. Order Printer #7  
17. Order Char Link  
18. Number of Bon  
19. Unit Stock  
8. Order Printer #1  
9. Order Printer #2  
10. Order Printer #3  
11. Order Printer #4  
12. Order Printer #5  
13. Order Printer #6  
14. Order Printer #7  
15. Order Char Link  
16. Number of Bon  
7. Order Printer #1  
8. Order Printer #2  
9. Order Printer #3  
10. Order Printer #4  
11. Order Printer #5  
12. Order Printer #6  
13. Order Printer #7  
14. Order Char Link  
15. Number of Bon  
5. Unit Stock  
20. Minimum Stock  
21. Set Menu Table  
22. List Link #1  
23. List Link #2  
24. List Link #3  
17. List Link #1  
18. List Link #2  
19. List Link #3  
20. List Link #4  
16. List Link #1  
17. List Link #2  
18. List Link #3  
19. List Link #4  
25. List Link #4  
26. Open PLU  
27. Zero Unit Price  
28. Negative Price  
29. Hash Item  
6. Zero Unit Price  
21. Zero Unit Price  
22. Negative Price  
23. Hash Item  
20. Zero Unit Price  
21. Negative Price  
22. Hash Item  
30. Full hash item  
31. High Amount Limit  
32. Low Digit Limit  
33. Multiple VLD  
34. Use main item amt only  
35. Use premium item of set  
24. Full hash item  
25. High Amount Limit  
26. Low Digit Limit  
27. Multiple VLD  
23. Full hash item  
24. High Amount Limit  
25. Low Digit Limit  
26. Multiple VLD  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-6 Programming individual program  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
v
0.00  
4. Select 6. Individual PGMand press the <YES> key.  
Select a job you want to program  
5. Select jobs listed below.  
Individual PGM  
1. Receipt Type  
2. Item Type  
3. Group Link  
19. Unit Stock: 0.001 - 99.9999  
20. MinimumStock:0.001-99.9999  
21. Set Menu table  
22. List Link #1  
23. List Link #2  
24. List Link #3  
25. List Link #4  
26. Open PLU  
27. Zero Unit Price  
Individual PGM  
1.Receipt Type  
2.Item Type  
3.Group Link  
4.Dept Link  
4. Dept Link  
5.Sub-Dept Link  
6.Taxable status  
7.Commission  
5. Sub-Dept Link  
6. Taxable status  
7. Commission  
8. Selective item  
9. Order color  
8.Selective item  
v
0.00  
10. Order Print #1  
11. Order Print #2  
12. Order Print #3  
13. Order Print #4  
14. Order Print #5  
15. Order Print #6  
16. Order Print #7  
17. Order Char Link  
18. Number of Bon: 0 - 9  
and press the <YES> key.  
28. Negative Price  
29. Hash Item  
30. Full hash item  
31. High Amount Limit: 0 - 999999  
32. Low Digit Limit: 0, 1 - 7  
33. Multiple VLD  
34. Use main item amt  
35. Use premium item 0  
Individual PGM  
Receipt Type  
Normal Item  
Enter PLU No or  
touch keys.  
0.00  
6. Selectanappropriaterecordandpressthe<YES>/<NO>key  
or enter the numeric value and press the <YES> key.  
Receipt Type  
Normal Item  
0001-004  
0002-004  
0003-004  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
0.00  
7. Enter PLU Nos. or press keys you want to program.  
8. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7 Programming key function program  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
v
0.00  
4. Select 7. Function Keyand press the <YES> key.  
Function Key  
Cash  
Charge  
Check  
RC  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
PD  
%-  
%+  
Subtotal  
Void  
0.00  
5. Enter program code (refer to the worksheet on the following  
pages) and press the function key.  
Key descriptor  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
NOTE: Press an appropriate function key without number entry on the keyboard, it shows  
current setting.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-1 Worksheet for cash, charge, credit and check  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number (0 ~9)  
Allowable number of validation printing (0means no limitation)  
:
*1 *3 *4  
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Force validation operation. *1 *3 *4  
a
b
c
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Print check number barcode on receipt.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Restriction (to 00, 25, 50, 75) on last two digits for amount  
tendered (Only for <CASH> in Danish rounding)  
;
Always 0”  
D9  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Force batch slip printing. *1 *4  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b+c)  
D8  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Force check endorsement printing (Only for <CHECK>). *3 *4  
Force check printing (Only for <CHECK>). *3 *4  
Prohibit entry of a partial payment  
Prohibit the entry of the amount tendered.  
Force entry of the amount tendered.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Print VAT breakdown. *1 *2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Check cashing commission (Only for <CHECK>) *3  
Amount = 0  
Rate = 2  
1 Use an amount  
2 Use a rate  
Validation amount *3  
1 Print subtotal amount 2 Print amount tendered  
Subtotal = 0  
Tender = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
No change due is made in tendering operation.  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Issue receipt while check tracking/clerk interrupt.  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
High amount limit specification for subtotal and tendering  
amounts. *3  
: :  
D4 D3  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
: :  
D2 D1  
High amount limit specification for change amount due.  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
*1 Those are valid options for AUTO CASH as well.  
*2 Those are valid options for Single item as well.  
*3 Those are valid options for Cashing a check as well.  
*4 Those are valid options for Currency exchange (include partial tender) as well.  
P-118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-2 Worksheet for new balance  
Description  
Allowable number of validation printing (0means no limitation)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number (0 ~9)  
:
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
Force validation operation.  
Print check number barcode on receipt.  
Always 0”  
:
(a+b)  
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
;
D9  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
Force batch slip printing.  
Open drawer when the key is pressed.  
Always 0”  
:
(a+b)  
D8  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
;
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
Print VAT breakdown.  
Service charge  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
Amount = 0  
Rate = 2  
b
1 Use an amount  
2 Use a rate  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D5  
Issue receipt while check tracking/clerk interrupt.  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-3 Worksheet for text print, text recall  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
Start record number of displaying TEXT RECALL WINDOW”  
(00means 01.)  
: :  
D9 D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow clerk or mode change after the text recallkey  
depression. (effective only for text recallkey)  
:
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Print characters to sales receipt printer.  
Significant  
number  
Order character record No. (01 ~ 99)  
(00clears programming)  
: :  
D6 D5  
Black = 0  
Red = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
Printing color (effective only for order)  
Display/print with quantity.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Staydown TEXT RECALL WINDOW”  
(effective only for text recallkey)  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Print characters to order printer 1.  
Print characters to order printer 2.  
Print characters to order printer 3.  
Print characters to order printer 4.  
Print characters to order printer 5.  
Print characters to order printer 6.  
Print characters to order printer 7.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
P-120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-4 Worksheet for check print  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
:
D7  
Number of back feed lines before printing (0 ~ 9)  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
4-3-7-5 Worksheet for clerk transfer  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Clerk number  
1 Memory number  
:
D7  
2 Clerk secret number  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
4-3-7-6 Worksheet for table transfer  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Allow to add checks while table transferring.  
Transfer the customer number.  
Transfer only total amounts. (ST transfer)  
Auto check transfer  
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Receipt is issued, even if the receipt switch is off.  
Print receipt.  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D5  
;;;;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
4-3-7-7 Worksheet for tip  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Multiple validation  
:
If No, only one validation printing is possible.)  
Always 0000”  
D11  
; ; ; ;  
D10 D9 D8 D7  
; ; ;  
D6 D5 D4  
Always 000”  
Significant  
number  
High digit limitation (HDL) for manually entered unit price  
(9means NOT allow manual entry)  
:
D3  
; ;  
D2 D1  
Always 00”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-8 Worksheet for loan, pick up  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
:
Allowable number of validation printing (0means no limitation)  
Force validation operation. (only effective after receipt issuance)  
Always 00000”  
number (0 ~9)  
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D10  
; ; ; ; ;  
D9 D8 D7 D6 D5  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
: :  
D4 D3  
High amount limit specification for entering amounts  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
; ;  
D2 D1  
Always 00”  
4-3-7-9 Worksheet for received on account, paid out  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number (0 ~9)  
:
D11  
Allowable number of validation printing (0means no limitation)  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D10  
Force validation operation.  
; ; ; ; ;  
D9 D8 D7 D6 D5  
Always 00000”  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
: :  
High amount limit specification for entering amounts  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
D4 D3  
;
D2  
Always 0”  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
Enter numbers after registration.  
P-122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-10 Worksheet for plus, minus, coupon  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Multiple validation  
(If No, only one validation printing is possible.)  
:
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
;
D10  
Always 0”  
U.S., Singapore:  
Taxable status 1  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
Taxable status 2  
Taxable status 3  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Canada:  
Taxable 1 = 01, Taxable 2 = 02, Taxable 3 = 03, Taxable 4 = 04  
Taxable 1 & 2 = 05, Taxable 1 & 3 = 06,Taxable 1 & 4 = 07  
All taxable = 08, Non taxable = 00  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D9 D8  
Other area:  
Significant  
numbers  
Taxable status 01 ~ 10 (00means Non-tax)  
:
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
Allow credit balance. (, CPN only)  
Always 00”  
D7  
; ;  
D6 D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow key operation after <SUBTOTAL>.  
Allow key operation after item registration.  
a
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
b
High digit limitation (HDL) for manually entered unit price  
(9means NOT allow manual entry.)  
:
D3  
Significant  
number  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Commission 1  
Commission 2  
Always 0”  
a
:
(a+b)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
;
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-11 Worksheet for deposit+, deposit–  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
Force validation operation.  
:
(a+b)  
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
b
Multiple validation (If No, only one validation is possible.)  
; ;  
D9 D8  
Always 00”  
DEPO+ = 0  
:
Key attribution  
Open cash drawer.  
DEPO= 1  
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
:
D6  
Media definition:  
Cash = 0, charge = 1, check = 2, credit = 3  
Significant  
number  
:
D5  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
: :  
D4 D3  
High amount limit specification for entering amounts  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
; ;  
D2 D1  
Always 00”  
4-3-7-12 Worksheet for void  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
:
D2  
Item delete (When Nois selected, only a line can be deleted.)  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
:
D1  
Select void reason.  
4-3-7-13 Worksheet for check endorsement  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
:
Line number of auto-back feed before printing (0 ~ 9)  
D7  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
P-124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-14 Worksheet for discount, premium  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Multiple validation  
(If No, only one validation printing is possible.)  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D11  
;
D10  
Always 0”  
U.S., Singapore:  
Taxable status 1  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
Taxable status 2  
Taxable status 3  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Canada:  
Taxable 1 = 01, Taxable 2 = 02, Taxable 3 = 03, Taxable 4 = 04  
Taxable 1 & 2 = 05, Taxable 1 & 3 = 06,Taxable 1 & 4 = 07  
All taxable = 08, Non taxable = 00  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D9 D8  
Other area:  
Significant  
numbers  
Taxable status 01 ~ 10 (00means Non-tax)  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Allow manual override.  
All taxable  
a
:
(a+b)  
D7  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
b
:
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow key operation after <SI/ST>.  
:
D5  
Rounding:  
Round off = 0, cut off = 1, round up = 2  
Significant  
number  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow key operation after <SUBTOTAL>.  
Allow key operation after item registration.  
Always 0”  
a
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
b
;
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Commission 1  
a
:
(a+b)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Commission 2  
b
;
D1  
Always 0”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-15 Worksheet for receipt  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Maximum number of post receipts (0 ~ 9)  
(0means 1 post receipt.)  
:
D12  
; ; ; ;  
D11 D10 D9 D8  
Always 0000”  
1 = 0  
2 = 2  
Form of post receipt and guest receipt:  
a
b
a
b
1 Print out, 2 Display  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Print current time on guest receipt.  
Clear finalized check.  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Issue post receipt after clerk interrupt/check tracking  
Always 00”  
; ;  
D5 D4  
Significant  
number  
Issue guest receipt to order printer n (n = 1 ~ 7).  
(0means issuing to R/J.)  
:
D3  
Significant  
number  
Line number of guest bottom message (00 ~ 10):  
(00means no bottom message.)  
: :  
D2 D1  
4-3-7-16 Worksheet for non-add, non-add/NS  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Allow mode change or clerk change after non add registration as  
first transaction. (only for non-add function)  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
:
D7  
Order character record number (00 ~ 99):  
(00means no setting.)  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D6 D5  
Red = 1  
Black = 0  
:
D4  
Order printing color  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
Print out to Order printer#1.  
Print out to Order printer#2.  
Print out to Order printer#3.  
Print out to Order printer#4.  
Print out to Order printer#5.  
Print out to Order printer#6.  
Print out to Order printer#7.  
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
:
(a+b+c)  
D2  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
:
D1  
P-126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-17 Worksheet for customer  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Input method:  
Allow replacement = 0, Prohibit replacement = 1,  
Add enter value = 2  
Significant  
number  
:
D7  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
4-3-7-18 Worksheet for arrangement  
Description  
Enable operation in REG mode.  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable operation in REF mode.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable operation in REGmode.  
Enable operation in PGM1 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM2 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM3 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM4 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM5 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM6 mode.  
Enable operation in Auto PGM to CF card mode  
Enable operation in Auto PGM mode.  
Enable operation in X/Z mode.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable operation in Manager mode.  
Enable operation in Collection/Consolidation mode.  
Arrangement file number  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
D7 D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Arrangement table number  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-19 Worksheet for currency exchange  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
:
D7  
Define amount symbol. (1 ~ 4)  
Significant  
number  
:
D6  
Define foreign currency totalizer. (1 ~ 3)  
Significant  
number  
Rounding:  
Round off = 0, cut off = 1, round up = 2  
:
D5  
;
D4  
Always 0”  
Significant  
number  
Monetary mode (0 ~ 2):  
º00 = 2, º0 = 1, 0 = 0  
:
D3  
Decimal = 0  
Comma = 1  
Monetary symbol for decimal  
Monetary symbol for separator  
a
:
(a+b)  
D3  
Comma = 0  
Decimal = 4  
b
Significant  
number  
Assigning drawer number (0 ~ 2)  
(0means drawer 1.)  
:
D1  
4-3-7-20 Worksheet for slip  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Force slip batch printing from the beginning of the transaction.  
a
(If No, controlled by general function.)  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print current time on slip.  
(This option works only at batch print with whole transaction.)  
b
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Clear finalized check.  
Always 0000”  
D6  
; ; ; ;  
D5 D4 D3 D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D1  
Print Euro total line.  
4-3-7-21 Worksheet for T/S, TAST  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Taxable status (00, 01 ~ 10)  
(00means taxable 1.)  
: :  
D9 D8  
; ; ;  
Always 000”  
Always 0000”  
D7 D6 D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
P-128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-22 Worksheet for open  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D7  
Release high amount limit  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
4-3-7-23 Worksheet for open 2  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Release customer number compulsory.  
Release table number compulsory.  
Release check number compulsory.  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
a
b
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Release credit balance error. (If Yes, you can finalize the  
transaction even if the subtotal is negative.)  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Release guest receipt compulsory.  
Release validation compulsory.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Release check endorsement compulsory.  
Release check print compulsory.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Release slip auto batch print compulsory.  
Release slip manual batch print compulsory.  
Release <LIST> stay down compulsory (Min/Max No.).  
Release seat number compulsory.  
Release tip declaration compulsory.  
Release eat-in/take-out compulsory.  
Always 0”  
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D3  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
;
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-24 Worksheet for clerk number  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Clerk secret number (0000 ~ 9999)  
(0000means no secret number.)  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
4-3-7-25 Worksheet for operator X/Z  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
a
1 Issue stand-alone report./2 Issue consolidation report.  
1 Print report./2 Display report.  
Always 000000”  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
1 = 0  
2 = 2  
b
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
4-3-7-26 Worksheet for subtotal, merchandise subtotal  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Multiple validation  
(If No, only one validation printing is possible.)  
:
D11  
; ; ; ;  
D10 D9 D8 D7  
Always 0000”  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
a
b
Display subtotal in Euro (sub currency) (ST only)  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Display subtotal in Euro (sub currency)  
and local (main) currency in turn. (ST 0nly)  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Include add-on tax amount. (ST only)  
Print when key is pressed.  
Always 0000”  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
P-130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-27 Worksheet for cancel  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
2 = 0  
1 = 1  
A range of cancellation:  
a
1Complete cancellation, 2Current receipt only  
:
(a+b)  
D1  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Correct set menu/pulldown link while it is registered.  
b
4-3-7-28 Worksheet for multiplication, quantity/for, square, cube, Ketten Bon  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Multiplication procedure: (Ketten Bon and <X> only)  
1 Quantity × Amount, 2 Amount × Quantity  
:
D6  
Significant  
number  
Rounding:  
Round off = 0, cut off = 1, round up = 2  
:
D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
4-3-7-29 Worksheet for selective item subtotal  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Selective item status (0, 1, 2):  
Selective item 1 = 0/1, selective item 2 = 2  
Significant  
number  
:
D11  
; ; ; ; ;  
Always 00000”  
Always 00000”  
D10 D9 D8 D7 D6  
; ; ; ; ;  
D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
4-3-7-30 Worksheet for open check  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Display = 2  
Print = 0  
:
D7  
Display report./Print report  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
4-3-7-31 Worksheet for list  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
Record No. of linking pulldown menu group (4).  
D12 D11 D10  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
Record No. of linking pulldown menu group (3).  
Record No. of linking pulldown menu group (2).  
Record No. of linking pulldown menu group (1).  
D9 D8 D7  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
D6 D5 D4  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
D3 D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-32 Worksheet for tax exempt  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
U.S., Singapore:  
Exempt tax 1  
a
b
c
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
Exempt tax 2  
Exempt tax 3  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
Canada:  
Exempt all = 00  
Significant  
numbers  
Exempt tax 1 = 01, Exempt tax 2 = 02, Exempt tax 3 = 03,  
Exempt tax 4 = 04, Exempt tax 1 & 2 = 05,  
Exempt tax 1 & 3 = 06, Exempt tax 1 & 4 = 07  
: :  
D9 D8  
Significant  
number  
Other area:  
Exempt all = 00, Exempt tax 1 ~ 10 = 01 ~ 10  
; ; ; ;  
Always 0000”  
Always 000”  
D7 D6 D5 D4  
; ; ;  
D3 D2 D1  
4-3-7-33 Worksheet for clock-in/clock-out  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
The purpose of uses:  
Significant  
numbers  
Use both clock-in and clock-out = 0  
Use only clock-in = 1  
:
D2  
Use only clock-out = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D1  
Print when clock-in or clock-out keys are pressed.  
4-3-7-34 Worksheet for break-in/break-out  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
The propose of uses:  
Significant  
numbers  
Use both break-in and break-out = 0  
Use only break-in = 1  
:
D2  
Use only break-out =2  
;
D1  
Always 0”  
P-132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-7-35 Worksheet for eat-in/take-out  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
U.S., Singapore:  
Exempt tax 1  
a
b
c
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
Exempt tax 2  
Exempt tax 3  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
Canada:  
Exempt all = 00  
Significant  
number  
Exempt tax 1 = 01, Exempt tax 2 = 02, Exempt tax 3 = 03,  
Exempt tax 4 = 04, Exempt tax 1 & 2 = 05,  
Exempt tax 1 & 3 = 06, Exempt tax 1 & 4 = 07  
: :  
D9 D8  
Significant  
numbers  
Other area:  
Exempt all = 00, Exempt tax 1 ~ 10 = 01 ~ 10  
; ;  
D7 D6  
Always 00”  
Not print = 0  
Print = 4  
:
Print when the key is pressed.  
Always 0000”  
D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
4-3-7-36 Worksheet for store  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Print VAT breakdown.  
Print receipt.  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
4-3-7-37 Worksheet for new check, new/old check  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Enable auto check assignment  
D7  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
4-3-7-38 Worksheet for round repeat  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Perform new balance after round repeat.  
a
:
(a+b)  
D1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Include plus/minus, premium/discount result to round  
repeat amount  
b
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-7-39 Worksheet for shift PLU  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Shift:  
:
D2  
1 Status, 2 Staydown  
Significant  
number  
Define assigning shift PLU number. (0, 1 ~ 8)  
(0is treated as 1.)  
:
D1  
4-3-7-40 Worksheet for receipt on/off  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Receipt off (only effective for SA-3015, 00for other printer)  
1 Both receipt and journal off, 2 Receipt only  
:
D1  
4-3-7-41 Worksheet for old check  
Description  
Enable to open the finalized check.  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
4-3-7-42 Worksheet for Dutch account  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
Maximum customer numbers for one Dutch account  
(00is treated as 99.)  
: :  
D2 D1  
4-3-7-43 Worksheet for tray total  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Accumulate Tray totalto the key totalizer, whenever the  
<TRAY TOTAL> key is pressed twice.  
:
D1  
4-3-7-44 Worksheet for recall  
Description  
Enable to open the closed check.  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
P-134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3-8 Programming shift PLU program  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
v
0.00  
4. Select 8. Shift PLUand press the <YES> key.  
Key Feature  
Shift PLU  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0005  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
0.00  
5. Select an appropriate item directly, by entering record No. or  
by entering PLU No. and press the <YES> key.  
Memory No.  
1
2nd Price  
3rd Price  
4th Price  
5th Price  
6th Price  
7th Price  
8th Price  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select an appropriate price and enter the unit price.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
4-3-9 Programming scanning PLU link program  
Operation  
Key Feature  
Key Feature  
2.PLU 2nd@  
^
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.Individual PGM  
7.Function Key  
8.Shift PLU  
9.Scanning PLU link  
0.00  
4. Select 9. Scanning PLU linkand press the <YES> key.  
Scanning PLU link  
Scanning PLU link  
1.Append/Mod PLU  
2.Delete PLU  
0.00  
5. If you append a new PLU or modify an existing PLU, select  
Append/Mod PLU. If you delete an existing PLU, select  
Delete PLU.  
Add/modify PLU  
Append/Mod PLU  
Please scan the code  
0.00  
6. Scanning the barcode or enter the PLU code and press the  
<OBR>.  
After this step, the PLU programming menu is shown.  
Refer to the Programming PLU features.  
PLU CODE 4912345678903  
Use Random code  
Descriptor  
123456  
PLU0001  
Price  
0.00  
Normal Item  
Normal Item  
--------  
--------  
--------  
Non Tax  
Receipt type  
Item type  
Group Link  
Dept Link  
Sub-Dept Link  
Taxable status  
Commission  
None  
Selective item  
Nonev  
0.00  
P-136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Delete PLU  
Delete PLU  
Please scan the code  
0.00  
6. Scanning the barcode or enter the PLU code and press the  
<OBR>.  
After this step, go to the step 5 automatically.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3  
P-138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Program 2 ............................................................................... P-140  
5-1. Character programming ......................................................................... P-140  
5-1-1  
5-1-2  
5-1-3  
Character programming keyboard .............................................................. P-140  
Inputting characters by code....................................................................... P-142  
After completing to input characters ........................................................... P-142  
5-2. Programming item descriptors ............................................................... P-143  
5-2-1  
5-2-2  
5-2-3  
5-2-4  
5-2-5  
5-2-6  
5-2-7  
Programming PLU item descriptors ............................................................ P-143  
Programming PLU 2nd unit price descriptors ............................................. P-144  
Programming subdepartment descriptors................................................... P-144  
Programming department descriptors......................................................... P-145  
Programming PLU/subdepartment/department descriptors by range......... P-146  
Copying PLU descriptors to PLU 2nd unit price.......................................... P-147  
Programming function key descriptors........................................................ P-148  
5-3. Programming characters and messages ............................................... P-149  
5-3-1  
5-3-2  
5-3-3  
5-3-4  
5-3-5  
5-3-6  
5-3-7  
5-3-8  
5-3-9  
Programming receipt message, slip message and guest receipt message P-149  
Programming text recall message .............................................................. P-150  
Programming order character link............................................................... P-150  
Programming fixed totalizer descriptors...................................................... P-151  
Programming group character .................................................................... P-152  
Programming special characters ................................................................ P-152  
Programming report headers ...................................................................... P-154  
Programming endorsement message......................................................... P-155  
Programming GT character ........................................................................ P-155  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
5. Program 2  
5-1. Character programming  
There are two methods you can use to input characters: using a character programming  
keyboard (menu sheet) for direct input, or using character codes to specify the characters.  
5-1-1 Character programming keyboard  
When you enter the Program 2 mode, the keyboard becomes a character programming  
keyboard (shown below).  
Â
Á
À
Ä
1
Ô
Ó
Ò
Ö
2
Û
Ú
Ù
Ü
3
Î
Í
Ê
É
È
Ë
5
Ç
Å
Ø
£
ƒ
¿
¡
â
á
à
ä
!
ô
ó
û
ú
ù
ü
#
e
d
c
î
í
ê
é
è
ë
%
t
ç
å
æ
ñ
^
ø
ÿ
Ã
ª
º
ã
y˜  
˜
Y
Ì
Æ
Ñ
6
ß
±
ò
ì
¬
¤
(
Ï
Õ
7
<<  
8
I
>>  
9
_
ö
ï
õ
&
u
j
¢
'
4
R
F
V
0
P
;
-
[
=
]
@
w
s
$
r
f
)
_
{
+
}
*
Q
A
Z
W
S
E
D
C
T
G
B
Y
U
J
O
L
q
a
z
y
i
o
l
p
:
H
N
K
,
'
`
g
b
h
n
k
"
~
¥
X
M
.
/
\
x
v
m
<
>
?
CAP SHIFT  
INS  
DEL DBL  
ESC/  
SKIP  
C
INS  
AB  
_
A_B  
AC  
INSERT  
DELETE  
7 8 9  
4 5 6  
1 2 3  
0 A B  
DEL  
DBL  
CAP  
SHIFT  
AB_  
C
PAGE  
UP  
NO  
#-2  
#-1  
DOUBLE  
LETTER  
A
A
A
A
A
a
a
a
HOME  
CAPITAL  
LETTER  
PAGE  
DOWN  
small  
letter  
YES  
a
P-140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Character programming keyboard (Menu sheet)  
The character programming keyboard has an upper case CAPsetting and a SHIFT”  
setting. Its initial setting is CAP setting, which remains in effect until you press the  
<SHIFT> key.  
After you press <SHIFT>, the shift setting remains in effect until you press the uppercase  
<CAP> key again. Note that neither the <SHIFT> nor <CAP> key operation is counted as  
a character during programming.  
Pressthe<DBL>keytospecifythatthenextcharacteryouinputisadouble-sizecharacter.  
Each double-size character counts as two normal size characters.  
Press the <INS> at the insertion point to insert a character, or press the <DEL> key at the  
deletion point to delete a character.  
The <Left Arrow> and <Right Arrow> key moves the insertion/deletion point.  
No.  
Descriptor  
1 PLU0001  
2 PLU0002  
3 PLU0003  
4 PLU0004  
5 PLU0005  
6 PLU0006  
7 PLU0007  
8 PLU0008  
9 PLU0009  
10 PLU0010  
11 PLU0011  
v
PLU0001  
0.00  
R
A
1
Icon (It shows a sort of the character input)  
A
a
A
a
A a  
a A  
or  
or  
or  
<Shift>  
<Cap>  
<DBL>  
<INS>  
<DEL>  
A
A
a
a
PLU0001 PLU0001  
PLU0001 LU0001  
Q
q
PLU0001 QLU0001  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
5-1-2 Inputting characters by code  
You can also program text by inputting codes that correspond to the characters you want  
to input. A list of character codes is given in the table below.  
You must also use the <B> key on the 10-key pad during character code programming to  
fix character codes for the last input character.  
Character code table  
Chara  
Code  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
Chara  
Code  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
Chara  
@
A
B
Code  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
Chara  
Code  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
Chara  
Code  
96  
Chara  
Code  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
Chara Code  
Space  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
:
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
[
a
b
c
d
e
f
p
q
r
Ç
ü
é
â
ä
à
å
ç
ê
ë
è
î
128  
129  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
136  
137  
138  
139  
140  
141  
142  
143  
!
#
$
%
&
97  
98  
C
99  
s
D
E
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
110  
111  
t
u
v
w
x
y
z
{
|
F
G
H
I
g
h
i
(
)
*
+
,
J
j
;
K
L
k
l
<
=
>
?
\
ì
.
M
N
O
]
m
n
o
}
~
ï
^
Ä
Å
/
_
Chara  
É
Code  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
Chara  
Code  
160  
161  
162  
163  
164  
165  
166  
167  
168  
169  
170  
171  
172  
173  
174  
175  
Chara  
Code  
176  
177  
178  
179  
180  
181  
182  
183  
184  
185  
186  
187  
188  
189  
190  
191  
Chara  
Code  
192  
193  
194  
195  
196  
197  
198  
199  
200  
201  
202  
203  
204  
205  
206  
207  
Chara  
Code  
208  
209  
210  
211  
212  
213  
214  
215  
216  
217  
218  
219  
220  
221  
222  
223  
Chara  
Code  
224  
225  
226  
227  
228  
229  
230  
231  
232  
233  
234  
235  
236  
237  
238  
239  
Chara Code  
240  
á
í
I
Ó
ß
æ
Æ
ô
II  
III  
D
Ê
Ë
È
±
241  
242  
243  
244  
245  
246  
247  
248  
249  
250  
251  
252  
253  
254  
255  
ó
ú
ñ
Ñ
ª
Ô
Ò
õ
ö
ò
Á
Â
À
Õ
µ
p
û
ã
Í
Î
Ï
ù
º
Ã
ÿ
¿
¨
P
Ö
Ü
ø
Ú
Û
Ù
y`  
1/2  
1/4  
¡
£
`
Ø
×
ƒ
¢
Y
«
¥
Ì
Double  
size  
»
¤
5-1-3 After completing to input characters  
After completion of inputting characters (by both character keyboard and character  
codes), it is necessary to press the <YES> key when you assign these characters to a key.  
P-142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Programming item descriptors  
Preparation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P2C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 2 mode.  
PGM-2  
1.Item Descriptor  
2.Char & Message  
0.00  
3. Select 1. Item Descriptorand press the <YES> key.  
5-2-1 Programming PLU item descriptors  
Operation  
Item Descriptor  
Item Descriptor  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
7.Char & Press Key  
0.00  
4. Select 1. PLUand press the <YES> key.  
Item Descriptor  
PLU  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
5. Select the PLU directly, or by entering record No. and press  
the <YES> key or by entering random code and press the  
<PLU No.> key.  
0.00  
No.  
Descriptor  
1 PLU0001  
2 PLU0002  
3 PLU0003  
4 PLU0004  
5 PLU0005  
6 PLU0006  
7 PLU0007  
8 PLU0008  
9 PLU0009  
6. After pressing the <YES> key again, the original descriptors  
are shown in the lower column of the display. Then enter  
characters (max. 24 characters) and press the <YES> key to  
fix them.  
10 PLU0010  
11 PLU0011  
v
PLU0001  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
5-2-2 Programming PLU 2nd unit price descriptors  
Operation  
Item Descriptor  
Item Descriptor  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
7.Char & Press Key  
0.00  
4. Select 2. PLU 2nd@and press the <YES> key.  
Item Descriptor  
PLU 2nd@  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
5. Select the PLU directly, or by entering record No. and press  
the <YES> key or by entering random code and press the  
<PLU No.> key.  
0.00  
No.  
Descriptor  
1 PLU0001  
2 PLU0002  
3 PLU0003  
4 PLU0004  
5 PLU0005  
6 PLU0006  
7 PLU0007  
8 PLU0008  
9 PLU0009  
6. After pressing the <YES> key again, the original descriptors  
are shown in the lower column of the display. Then enter  
characters (max. 24 characters) and press the <YES> key to  
fix them.  
10 PLU0010  
11 PLU0011  
v
PLU0001  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
5-2-3 Programming subdepartment descriptors  
Operation  
Item Descriptor  
Item Descriptor  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
7.Char & Press Key  
0.00  
4. Select 3. Sub-Departmentand press the <YES> key.  
P-144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Item Descriptor  
Sub-Department  
1.SUBDEPT01  
2.SUBDEPT02  
3.SUBDEPT03  
4.SUBDEPT04  
0.00  
5. Select the <SUBDEPARTMENT> directly or by entering  
subdepartment No. and press the <YES> key.  
No.  
Descriptor  
1 SUBDEPT01  
2 SUBDEPT02  
3 SUBDEPT03  
4 SUBDEPT04  
6. After pressing the <YES> key again, the original descriptors  
are shown in the lower column of the display. Then enter  
characters and press the <YES> key to fix them.  
SUBDEPT01  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
5-2-4 Programming department descriptors  
Operation  
Item Descriptor  
Item Descriptor  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
7.Char & Press Key  
0.00  
4. Select 4. Departmentand press the <YES> key.  
Item Descriptor  
Department  
1.DEPT01  
2.DEPT02  
3.DEPT03  
4.DEPT04  
0.00  
5. Select the <DEPARTMENT> directly, by entering depart-  
ment No. and press the <YES> key.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
No.  
Descriptor  
1 DEPT01  
2 DEPT02  
3 DEPT03  
4 DEPT04  
6. After pressing the <YES> key again, the original descriptors  
are shown in the lower column of the display. Then enter  
characters and press the <YES> key to fix them.  
DEPT01  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
5-2-5 Programming PLU/subdepartment/department descriptors by range  
Operation  
Item Descriptor  
Item Descriptor  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
7.Char & Press Key  
0.00  
4. Select 5. Rangeand press the <YES> key.  
Item Descriptor  
Range  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
0.00  
5. Select the subject you want to modify, PLU/PLU 2nd@/  
Sub-Department/Departmentand press the <YES> key.  
Item Descriptor  
Descriptor PLU0123  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
6. After pressing the <YES> key, enter characters and press the  
<YES> key.  
P-146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Item Descriptor  
Descriptor PLU0123  
Enter Start range  
123  
0
End range  
OK?  
YES  
7. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
0.00  
Item Descriptor  
Descriptor PLU0123  
Enter Start range  
123  
999  
End  
range  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
8. Press the <YES> key and return to the previous menu.  
5-2-6 Copying PLU descriptors to PLU 2nd unit price  
Operation  
Item Descriptor  
Item Descriptor  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
7.Char & Press Key  
0.00  
4. Select 6. PLU > 2nd@ Copyand press the <YES> key.  
Item Descriptor  
PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
Enter Start range  
123  
0
End range  
OK?  
YES  
5. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
0.00  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
Item Descriptor  
PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
Enter Start range  
123  
999  
End range  
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
6. Press the <YES> key and return to the previous menu.  
5-2-7 Programming function key descriptors  
Operation  
Item Descriptor  
Item Descriptor  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Range  
6.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
7.Char & Press Key  
0.00  
4. Select 7. Char & Press Keyand press the <YES> key.  
Item Descriptor  
Item Descriptor  
CASH  
0040-002  
178-001  
0042-002  
164-020  
RECEIVED ON ACC.  
5. a) Function keys (max. 16 characters)  
Enter characters, press the <YES> key to fix them and press  
the corresponding key.  
b) PLU (max. 24 characters)  
Enter charactes, press the <YES> key to fix them and press  
the corresponding <PLU> key or enter corresponding PLU  
No. and press the <PLU#> key.  
c) PLU 2nd @ (max. 24 characters)  
Enter characters and press the <2nd@> key and correspond-  
ing key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-3. Programming characters and messages  
Preparation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P2C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 2 mode.  
PGM-2  
1.Item Descriptor  
2.Char & Message  
0.00  
3. Select 2. Char & Messageand press the <YES> key.  
5-3-1 Programming receipt message, slip message and guest receipt message  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
1.Receipt/SLIP Msg  
2.Text Recall  
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
v
0.00  
4. Select 1. Receipt/SLIP Messageand press the <YES> key.  
Rec No.  
1 ~ 4  
5 ~ 8  
Message  
Receipt logo message  
Receipt commercial message  
Receipt bottom message  
Receipt/SLIP Msg  
0001-032 (Receipt Logo)  
YOUR RECEIPT  
9 ~ 12  
0002-032 (Receipt Logo)  
13 ~ 16 Bill top message  
THANK YOU  
0003-032 (Receipt Logo)  
17 ~ 20 Bill copy message  
21 ~ 24 Bill bottom message  
25 ~ 28 Slip logo message  
29 ~ 32 Slip intermediate message  
33 ~ 36 Slip bottom message  
37  
38 ~ 47 Guest bottom message  
48 Copy receipt message  
CALL AGAIN  
0004-032 (Receipt Commercial)  
0005-032 (Receipt Commercial)  
0006-032 (Receipt Commercial)  
Not used  
0.00  
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters (Maximum 40 characters) and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
5-3-2 Programming text recall message  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
1.Receipt/SLIP Msg  
2.Text Recall  
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
v
0.00  
4. Select 2. Text Recalland press the <YES> key.  
Text Recall  
0001-039  
********* Text Recall 1st line ********  
0002-039  
********* Text Recall 2nd line ********  
0003-039  
********* Text Recall 3rd line ********  
0004-039  
********* Text Recall 4th line ********  
0005-039  
********* Text Recall 5th line ********  
0006-039  
v
0.00  
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters (Maximum 40 characters) and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
5-3-3 Programming order character link  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
1.Receipt/SLIP Msg  
2.Text Recall  
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
v
0.00  
4. Select 3. Order Char Linkand press the <YES> key.  
Order Char Link  
0001-065  
Order Character 1  
0002-065  
Order Character 2  
0003-065  
Order Character 3  
0004-065  
Order Character 4  
0005-065  
Order Character 5  
0006-065  
v
0.00  
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters (Maximum 16 characters) and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-3-4 Programming fixed totalizer descriptors  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
1.Receipt/SLIP Msg  
2.Text Recall  
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
v
0.00  
4. Select 4. Fixed Totalizerand press the <YES> key.  
Fixed Totalizer  
0001-001  
GROSS  
0002-001  
NET  
0003-001  
CAID  
0004-001  
CATL  
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters (Maximum 16 characters) and press the <YES>  
key.  
0005-001  
CA-  
0006-001  
v
0.00  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Rec No.  
040  
041  
042  
043  
044  
045  
046  
047  
048  
049  
050  
051  
052  
053  
054  
055  
056  
057  
058  
059  
060  
061  
062  
063  
064  
065  
066  
067  
068  
069  
070  
071  
072  
073  
074  
075  
076  
077  
078  
Message  
Rec No.  
Message  
Gross sales total  
Net sales total  
Cash in drawer  
Cash declared amount (not used)  
Declared short cash amount (not used)  
Declared over cash amount (not used)  
Charge in drawer  
Charge declared amount (not used)  
Declared short charge amount (not used)  
Declared over charge amount (not used)  
Check in drawer  
Check declared amount (not used)  
Declared short check amount (not used)  
Declared over check amount (not used)  
Credit in drawer  
Credit declared amount (not used)  
Declared short credit amount (not used)  
Declared over credit amount (not used)  
Not used  
Not used  
Rounding  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
015  
016  
017  
018  
019  
020  
021  
022  
023  
024  
025  
026  
027  
028  
029  
030  
031  
032  
033  
034  
035  
036  
037  
038  
039  
ST transfer void  
Not used  
Not used  
Taxable amount 1  
Tax 1  
Tax exempt 1  
Taxable amount 2  
Tax 2  
Tax exempt 2  
Taxable amount 3  
Tax 3  
Tax exempt 3  
Taxable amount 4  
Tax 4  
Tax exempt 4  
Taxable amount 5  
Tax 5  
Tax exempt 5  
Taxable amount 6  
Tax 6  
Tax exempt 6  
Taxable amount 7  
Tax 7  
Tax exempt 7  
Taxable amount 8  
Tax 8  
Tax exempt 8  
Taxable amount 9  
Tax 9  
Tax exempt 9  
Taxable amount 10  
Tax 10  
Tax exempt 10  
Euro cash in drawer  
Euro charge in drawer  
Euro check in drawer  
Euro credit in drawer  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Refund mode total  
Customer count  
Average sales per customer  
Check cashing service fee  
New Balance fee  
Not used  
Clerk commission 1 total  
Clerk commission 2 total  
Foreign currency cash in drawer 1  
Foreign currency check in drawer 1  
Foreign currency cash in drawer 2  
Foreign currency check in drawer 2  
Foreign currency cash in drawer 3  
Foreign currency check in drawer 3  
Reduction  
Item return  
Clear counter  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
5-3-5 Programming group character  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
1.Receipt/SLIP Msg  
2.Text Recall  
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
v
0.00  
4. Select 5. Group Characterand press the <YES> key.  
Group Character  
0001-006  
GROUP01  
0002-006  
GROUP02  
0003-006  
GROUP03  
0004-006  
GROUP04  
0005-006  
GROUP05  
0006-006  
v
0.00  
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters (Maximum 16 characters) and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
5-3-6 Programming special characters  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
1.Receipt/SLIP Msg  
2.Text Recall  
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
v
0.00  
4. Select 6. Special Characterand press the <YES> key.  
Special Character  
COVERS  
0001-023  
@No / *  
0002-023  
NoCTX  
0003-023  
X
BUSY  
0004-023  
T1 T2 T3 T4 T5  
0005-023  
T12T13T14  
0006-023  
T23  
v
0.00  
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters and press the <YES> key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rec No.  
Contents  
Amount symbol (3), @(2), No (2), split pricing (1),  
Training filler (1)  
No. of item sold (2), Customer count (2), Square (6), Double sized customer count(6) NoCTX  
Multiplication (6)  
Recalling for a check (6)  
Taxable symbol 1 (3 each)  
Taxable symbol 2 (3 each)  
Taxable symbol 3 (3 each)  
Descriptor  
$ @No / *  
@No / *  
U.S.  
Others  
001  
002  
003  
COVERS  
BUSY  
BUSY  
T1 T2 T3 T4 T5  
T12T13T14 T23  
T1  
U.S.  
Others  
X
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
015  
016  
017  
018  
019  
020  
021  
022  
023  
024  
025  
026  
027  
028  
029  
030  
031  
032  
033  
034  
035  
036  
037  
038  
039  
040  
041  
042  
043  
044  
045  
046  
047  
048  
049  
050  
051  
052  
053  
054  
055  
056  
057  
058  
Foreign currency × 4 (2 each), Selective item symbol × 3 (1 each), Center dot (1)  
* * * * •  
Mode symbol 1 (4 each)  
REG  
RFR-  
MGR  
Mode symbol 2 (4 each)  
Mode symbol 3 (4)  
Decimal of amount, Decimal of quantity, Delimiter (1 each)  
A.M., P.M. (3 each)  
Slip continued (12), page (2)  
Online password (8)  
Display subtotal symbol (ST key) (16)  
Subtotal symbol (16)  
Total symbol (16)  
Change symbol (16)  
Check cashing fee (16)  
Check cashing amount (16)  
Bon message (16)  
Not used  
Check No. (12)  
Service total (16)  
Item discount total (16)  
House Bon quantity of item (16)  
Seat No. (16)  
Total symbol (X/Z report) (16)  
Clock-in symbol (16)  
Clock-out symbol (16)  
P
nX/Z  
TRG  
..,  
AM PM  
CONTINUED  
P
SUBTOTAL  
ST  
TL  
CG  
-
CACG  
** STUB **  
CHECK No.  
SRVC TL  
DISCOUNT  
HOUSE BON QTY  
SEAT#  
TL  
CLOCK-IN  
CLOCK-OUT  
BREAK-IN  
BREAK-OUT  
JOB  
WORK TIME  
BREAK TIME  
CASH TIP  
REGULAR TIME  
OVER TIME  
IN OUT BRK JOB#  
TIP WORK*  
COST  
NET SALES/HOUR  
COST/TRANSACTION  
EUREUR  
Break-in symbol (16)  
Break-out symbol (16)  
Job code symbol (16)  
Work time symbol (16)  
Break time symbol (16)  
Tip declaration symbol (16)  
Regular work hours (Employee report) (16)  
Overtime work hours (Employee report) (16)  
Employee report (1) (4 each)  
Employee report (2) (4 each), Edit symbol (1)  
Hourly labor pay (16)  
Hourly labor proceeds (16)  
Pay per transaction (16)  
Euro amount symbol (3)  
not used  
Occupied new check (Open check report) (16)  
Finalized check (Open check report) (16)  
not used  
NEW OPEN  
FINALIZED  
not used  
Unit price of shift PLU 1 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 2 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 3 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 4 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 5 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 6 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 7 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 8 (PLU report)  
Taxable symbol 4 (3 each)  
@1  
@2  
@3  
@4  
@5  
@6  
@7  
@8  
T6 T7 T8 T9 T10  
n: Program mode number (1 ~ 6)  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
5-3-7 Programming report headers  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
1.Receipt/SLIP Msg  
2.Text Recall  
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
v
0.00  
4. Select 7. Report Headerand press the <YES> key.  
Report Header  
0001-024  
FIXED TTL  
0002-024  
FREE FUNCTION  
0003-024  
SUB DEPT  
0004-024  
PLU  
0005-024  
DEPT  
0006-024  
v
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters (Maximum 16 characters) and press the <YES>  
key.  
0.00  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
Rec No.  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
015  
016  
017  
018  
019  
020  
021  
022  
023  
:
Contents  
Fixed totalizer report  
Transaction key report  
Subdepartment report  
PLU report  
Department report  
Group report  
Cashier/clerk report  
not used  
Hourly sales report  
Monthly sales report  
Flash (Financial) report  
Open check report  
Table analysis report  
PLU stock report  
Void causal report  
Descriptor  
FIXED TTL  
FREE FUNCTION  
SUB DEPT  
PLU  
DEPT  
GROUP  
CASHIER/CLERK  
HOURLY  
MONTHLY  
FLASH  
OPEN CHK  
TABLE ANALYSIS  
PLU STOCK  
VOID REASON  
Electronic journal report E-JOURNAL  
Time & Attendance  
Hourly labor  
Hourly item  
not used  
IDC (1) reset  
IDC (2) reset  
IDC (3) reset  
EMPLOYEE  
HOURLY LABOR  
HOURLY PRODUCT  
IDC(1) Clear  
IDC(2) Clear  
IDC(3) Clear  
030  
not used  
P-154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-3-8 Programming endorsement message  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
1.Receipt/SLIP Msg  
2.Text Recall  
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
v
0.00  
4. Select 8. Endorse Messageand press the <YES> key.  
Endorse Message  
0001-033  
****** Endorse Message 1st line *******  
0002-033  
****** Endorse Message 2nd line *******  
0003-033  
****** Endorse Message 3rd line *******  
0004-033  
****** Endorse Message 4th line *******  
0.00  
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters (Maximum 40 characters) and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
5-3-9 Programming GT character  
Operation  
Char & Message  
Char & Message  
2.Text Recall  
^
3.Order Char Link  
4.Fixed Totalizer  
5.Group Character  
6.Special Character  
7.Report Header  
8.Endorse Message  
9.GT Character  
0.00  
0.00  
4. Select 9. GT Characterand press the <YES> key.  
GT Character  
0001-020  
GT1  
0002-020  
GT2  
0003-020  
GT3  
5. Select the appropriate record, press the <YES> key, enter  
characters (Maximum 16 characters) and press the <YES>  
key.  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 2  
P-156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Program 1 ............................................................................... P-158  
6-1. Presetting date and time ........................................................................ P-158  
6-2. Programming unit price and rate............................................................ P-159  
6-2-1 Programming PLU unit price .......................................................................... P-159  
6-2-2 Programming PLU 2nd unit price ................................................................... P-160  
6-2-3 Programming PLU unit price and PLU 2nd unit price..................................... P-161  
6-2-4 Programming subdepartment unit price ......................................................... P-162  
6-2-5 Programming department unit price ............................................................... P-162  
6-2-6 Programming PLU/PLU 2nd@/subdepartment/  
department unit price by range...................................................................... P-163  
6-2-7 Copying PLU unit price to PLU 2nd unit price ................................................ P-165  
6-2-8 Programming amount or rate to keys ............................................................. P-166  
6-2-9 Programming unit price of shift PLU............................................................... P-167  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 1  
6. Program 1  
6-1. Presetting date and time  
Preparation:  
P1C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 1 mode.  
PGM-1  
1.Unit Price/Qty  
0.00  
Presetting time  
P1C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
PGM-1  
1.Unit Price/Qty  
10-10-01 12:34 00  
3. Enter the current time in four (hour, minute) digits or in five  
(hour, minute, tensecond)andpressthe<YES>key(24-hour  
system).  
Presetting date:  
P1C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
PGM-1  
1.Unit Price/Qty  
10-10-01 12:34 00  
3. Enter the current date in six digits (year, month, day order)  
and press the <YES> key.  
P-158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-2. Programming unit price and rate  
Preparation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P1C01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 1 mode.  
PGM-1  
1.Unit Price/Qty  
0.00  
3. Select 1. Unit Price/Qtyand press the <YES> key.  
6-2-1 Programming PLU unit price  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key v  
0.00  
4. Select 1. PLUand press the <YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
PLU  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
0.00  
5. Select the PLU directly, or by entering record No. and press  
the <YES> key or by entering random code and press the  
<PLU No.> key.  
No.  
Descriptor  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
PLU0004  
PLU0005  
PLU0006  
PLU0007  
PLU0008  
PLU0009  
PLU0010  
PLU0011  
Price  
@10.00  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
@20.00  
@30.00  
@40.00  
@50.00  
@60.00  
@70.00  
@80.00  
@90.00  
@100.00  
@110.00v  
10  
11  
6. Enter unit price and press the <YES> key to fix them.  
Pressing <YES> twice programs the same unit price to the  
next record.  
0.00  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 1  
6-2-2 Programming PLU 2nd unit price  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key v  
0.00  
4. Select 2. PLU 2nd@and press the <YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
PLU 2nd@  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
5. Select the PLU directly, or by entering record No. and press  
the <YES> key or by entering random code and press the  
<PLU No.> key.  
0.00  
No.  
Descriptor  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
PLU0004  
PLU0005  
PLU0006  
PLU0007  
PLU0008  
PLU0009  
PLU0010  
PLU0011  
Qty  
26.52  
Price  
@10.00  
No.  
Descriptor  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
PLU0004  
PLU0005  
PLU0006  
PLU0007  
PLU0008  
PLU0009  
PLU0010  
PLU0011  
Qty  
26.52  
Price  
@10.00  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0.00  
0.50  
1.75  
2.80  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
@20.00  
@30.00  
@40.00  
@50.00  
@60.00  
@70.00  
@80.00  
@90.00  
0.00  
0.50  
1.75  
2.80  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
@20.00  
@30.00  
@40.00  
@50.00  
@60.00  
@70.00  
@80.00  
@90.00  
10  
11  
0.00 @100.00  
0.00 @110.00v  
10  
11  
0.00 @100.00  
0.00 @110.00v  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select Qtyor Pricefield by the cursor keys and enter unit  
price and press the <YES> key to fix them.  
Pressing <YES> twice programs the same unit price to the  
next record.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-2-3 Programming PLU unit price and PLU 2nd unit price  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key v  
0.00  
4. Select 3. PLU & PLU 2nd@and press the <YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
PLU & PLU 2nd@  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
5. Select the PLU directly, or by entering record No. and press  
the <YES> key or by entering random code and press the  
<PLU No.> key.  
0.00  
No.  
Descriptor  
PLU0001  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
PLU0003  
PLU0004  
PLU0004  
PLU0005  
PLU0005  
PLU0006  
Qty  
12.26  
Price  
@1,234.00  
@1.00  
1
2
3
4
5
6
PLU 1st @  
PLU 2nd qty/@  
@20.00  
@2.00  
0.00  
0.50  
1.75  
2.80  
@30.00  
@3.00  
@40.00  
@4.00  
@50.00  
@5.00  
@60.00v  
0.00  
No.  
Descriptor  
PLU0001  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
PLU0003  
PLU0004  
PLU0004  
PLU0005  
PLU0005  
PLU0006  
Qty  
12.26  
Price  
@1,234.00  
@1.00  
No.  
Descriptor  
PLU0001  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
PLU0003  
PLU0004  
PLU0004  
PLU0005  
PLU0005  
PLU0006  
Qty  
Price  
@1,234.00  
@1.00  
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
12.26  
0.00  
0.50  
1.75  
2.80  
@20.00  
@2.00  
@20.00  
@2.00  
0.00  
0.50  
1.75  
2.80  
@30.00  
@3.00  
@30.00  
@3.00  
@40.00  
@4.00  
@40.00  
@4.00  
@50.00  
@5.00  
@50.00  
@5.00  
@60.00v  
@60.00v  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Select Qtyor Pricefield by the cursor keys and enter the  
unit price and press the <YES> key to fix them.  
Pressing <YES> twice programs the same unit price to the  
next record.  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 1  
6-2-4 Programming subdepartment unit price  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key v  
0.00  
4. Select 4. Sub-Departmentand press the <YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
Sub-Department  
1.SUBDEPT01  
2.SUBDEPT02  
3.SUBDEPT03  
4.SUBDEPT04  
0.00  
5. Select the subdepartment directly or by entering record No.  
and press the <YES> key.  
No.  
Descriptor  
SUBDEPT01  
SUBDEPT02  
SUBDEPT03  
SUBDEPT04  
Price  
1
2
3
4
@10.00  
@20.00  
@30.00  
@40.00  
6. Enter the unit price and press the <YES> key to fix them.  
Pressing <YES> twice programs the same unit price to the  
next record.  
0.00  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
6-2-5 Programming department unit price  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key v  
0.00  
4. Select 5. Departmentand press the <YES> key.  
P-162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Unit Price/Qty  
Department  
1.DEPT01  
2.DEPT02  
3.DEPT03  
4.DEPT04  
0.00  
5. Select the department directly or by entering record No. and  
press the <YES> key.  
No.  
Descriptor  
DEPT01  
Price  
1
2
3
4
@10.00  
@20.00  
@30.00  
@40.00  
DEPT02  
DEPT03  
DEPT04  
6. Enter the unit price and press the <YES> key to fix them.  
Pressing <YES> twice programs the same unit price to the  
next record.  
0.00  
7. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
6-2-6 Programming PLU/PLU 2nd@/subdepartment/department unit price by range  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key v  
0.00  
4. Select 6. Rangeand press the <YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
Range  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
0.00  
5. Select the subject you want to modify, PLU/PLU 2nd@/  
Sub-Department/Departmentand press the <YES> key.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 1  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
Qty  
12.00  
@0.00  
Price  
0.00  
Price  
Enter Start range  
0
0
Input Range Start  
Range End  
0000  
0000  
End  
range  
OK?  
YES  
OK?  
Yes  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
6. Enter the unit price (and Qty for PLU 2nd@) and press the  
<YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
10.00  
Price  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
OK?  
YES  
7. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
Unit Price/Qty  
10.00  
Price  
Enter Start range  
End range  
12  
25  
OK?  
YES  
8. Press the <YES> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-2-7 Copying PLU unit price to PLU 2nd unit price  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key v  
0.00  
4. Select 7. PLU > 2nd@ Copyand press the <YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
Enter Start range  
123  
0
End range  
OK?  
YES  
5. Enter the start range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It starts 0001if you skip to enter the start range.)  
Then enter the end range No. and press the <YES> key.  
(It ends the last record if you skip to enter the end range.)  
0.00  
0.00  
Unit Price/Qty  
PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
Enter Start range  
123  
999  
End range  
OK?  
YES  
6. Press the <YES> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 1  
6-2-8 Programming amount or rate to keys  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key v  
0.00  
4. Select 8.AMT/Rate to Keyand press the <YES> key.  
5. a) Function keys  
Unit Price/Qty  
Enter the unit price or rate and press the corresponding key.  
(CA, CHK, NB, +, , CPN, %+, %, CE)  
b) PLU  
Enter the PLU No., press the <PLU#> key, enter the unit  
price and press the <YES> key. Pressing <YES> twice  
programs the same unit price to the next record.  
Or enter the unit price and press the appropriate <PLU> key  
directly.  
0.00  
c) PLU 2nd @  
Enter unit price and Qty, and press the <2nd@> key and  
<YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
PLU0004  
0001-004  
@10.00  
+
@1.00  
5.50%  
%-  
CE  
CE  
0002-004  
@20.00  
105.0670  
0.2860  
0003-054  
@30.00  
0.00  
0004-054  
@40.00  
12.34  
CE  
0.2860  
6. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
P-166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-2-9 Programming unit price of shift PLU  
Operation  
Unit Price/Qty  
Unit Price/Qty  
2.PLU 2nd@  
^
3.PLU & PLU 2nd@  
4.Sub-Department  
5.Department  
6.Range  
7.PLU -> 2nd@ Copy  
8.AMT / Rate to Key  
9.Shift PLU  
0.00  
4. Select 9. Shift PLUand press the <YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
Shift PLU  
1.2nd Price  
2.3rd Price  
3.4th Price  
4.5th Price  
5.6th Price  
6.7th Price  
7.8th Price  
0.00  
5. Select the shift level and press the <YES> key.  
Unit Price/Qty  
Shift PLU  
1.PLU0001  
2.PLU0002  
3.PLU0003  
4.PLU0004  
5.PLU0005  
6.PLU0006  
7.PLU0007  
8.PLU0008  
v
0.00  
6. Select the PLU directly, or by entering record No. and press  
the <YES> key or by entering random code and press the  
<PLU No.> key.  
No.  
Descriptor  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
PLU0004  
PLU0005  
PLU0006  
PLU0007  
PLU0008  
PLU0009  
PLU0010  
PLU0011  
Price  
@10.00  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
@20.00  
@30.00  
@40.00  
@50.00  
@60.00  
@70.00  
@80.00  
@90.00  
10  
11  
@01@0.10..000000v  
7. Enter unit price and press the <YES> key to fix them.  
Pressing <YES> twice programs the same unit price to the  
next record.  
8. Press the <ESC> key to return to the previous menu.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 1  
P-168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Program 6 .............................................................................................. P-170  
7-1. Program read general procedure ........................................................... P-170  
7-2. Program read report sample .................................................................. P-171  
7-2-1  
7-2-2  
7-2-3  
7-2-4  
7-2-5  
7-2-6  
7-2-7  
7-2-8  
Unit Price/Qty.............................................................................................. P-171  
Item Descriptor............................................................................................ P-172  
Character and Message.............................................................................. P-172  
Machine feature .......................................................................................... P-176  
Clerk............................................................................................................ P-208  
Key feature.................................................................................................. P-220  
Keyboard..................................................................................................... P-242  
Memory allocation....................................................................................... P-242  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7. Program 6  
7-1. Program read general procedure  
Operation:  
1. Sign on a clerk (if necessary).  
P6C  
01  
10-10-01 12:34  
000000  
2. Press <PGM MODE> repeatedly to assign Program 6 mode.  
PGM-6  
1.PGM Read Report  
0.00  
3. Press the <YES> key.  
PGM Read Report  
PGM Read Report  
1.Unit Price/Qty  
2.Item Descriptor  
3.Char & Message  
4.Machine Feature  
5.Clerk  
6.Key Feature  
7.Keyboard  
8.Memory Alloc.  
0.00  
4. Select an appropriate job and press the <YES> key.  
PGM Read Report  
Unit Price/Qty  
1.PLU  
2.PLU 2nd@  
3.Sub-Department  
4.Department  
5.Function Key  
5. Select an appropriate job and press the <YES> key.  
The program read report is issued.  
0.00  
If the job requires range designation, the next screen will be  
appeared.  
PLU  
Enter Start range  
End range  
0
0
OK?  
YES  
0.00  
6. Enter the start and end range and press the <YES> key.  
The program read report is issued from the printer.  
P-170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2. Program read report sample  
7-2-1 Unit Price/Qty  
7-2-1-1. PLU unit price  
PLU0001  
0001-004PLU descriptor/Record No./File No.  
@12.34Unit Price  
0001-055Shift PLU  
@2.002nd unit price  
@3.003rd unit price  
@4.004th unit price  
@5.005th unit price  
@6.006th unit price  
@7.007th unit price  
@8.008th unit price  
0002-004  
PLU0002  
@1.00  
0002-055  
7-2-1-2. PLU 2nd unit price  
PLU0001  
0001-054PLU 2nd descriptor/Record No./File No.  
2
@23.45Unit quantity/2nd unit Price  
PLU0002  
0002-054  
@10.00  
1
PLU0003  
0003-054  
@2.00  
0
7-2-1-3. Subdepartment  
SUBDEPT01  
SUBDEPT02  
SUBDEPT03  
0001-003Subdepartment descriptor/Record No./File No.  
@1.00Unit Price  
0002-003  
@2.00  
0003-003  
@3.34  
7-2-1-4. Department  
DEPT01  
DEPT02  
DEPT03  
0001-005Department descriptor/Record No./File No.  
@12.34Unit Price  
0002-005  
@2.34  
0003-005  
@1.34  
7-2-1-5. Function key  
%-  
0013-002Function key descriptor/Record No./File No.  
0%Unit Price, percent rate or conversion rate  
-
0018-002  
@0.00  
CASH  
0035-002  
@0.00  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-2 Item Descriptor  
7-2-2-1. PLU  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
0001-004PLU descriptor/Record No./File No.  
0002-004  
0003-004  
7-2-2-2. PLU 2nd unit price  
PLU0001  
PLU0002  
PLU0003  
0001-054PLU 2nd descriptor/Record No./File No.  
0002-054  
0003-054  
7-2-2-3. Subdepartment  
SUBDEPT01  
SUBDEPT02  
SUBDEPT03  
0001-003Subdepartment descriptor/Record No./File No.  
0002-003  
0003-003  
7-2-2-4. Department  
DEPT01  
DEPT02  
DEPT03  
0001-005Department descriptor/Record No./File No.  
0002-005  
0003-005  
7-2-2-5. Function key  
RCT  
0001-002Function key descriptor/Record No./File No.  
NEW/OLD  
RC  
DISP ON/OFF  
CLK#1  
0002-002  
0003-002  
0004-002  
0005-002  
7-2-3 Character and Message  
7-2-3-1. Receipt/Slip message  
0001-032  
Record No./File No.  
Receipt message  
YOUR RECEIPT  
0002-032  
Rec No.  
1 ~ 4  
5 ~ 8  
Message  
Receipt logo message  
Receipt commercial message  
Receipt bottom message  
THANK YOU  
0003-032  
CALL AGAIN  
9 ~ 12  
0004-032  
13 ~ 16 Bill top message  
:
:
17 ~ 20 Bill copy message  
21 ~ 24 Bill bottom message  
25 ~ 28 Slip logo message  
29 ~ 32 Slip intermediate message  
33 ~ 36 Slip bottom message  
37  
38 ~ 47 Guest bottom message  
48 Copy receipt message  
Not used  
7-2-3-2. Text recall  
0001-039  
TEXT RECALL MESSAGE 01  
Record No./File No.  
Text recall message  
0002-039  
:
:
0010-039  
P-172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-3-3. Order character  
ORDER CHAR 1  
0001-065Order character/Record No./File No.  
ORDER CHAR 2  
0002-065  
:
:
ORDER CHAR 10  
0010-065  
7-2-3-4. Fixed totalizer  
GROSS  
NET  
CAID  
:
0001-001Descriptor/Record No./File No.  
0002-001  
0003-001  
:
EX10  
0074-001  
Rec No.  
040  
041  
042  
043  
044  
045  
046  
047  
048  
049  
050  
051  
052  
053  
054  
055  
056  
057  
058  
059  
060  
061  
062  
063  
064  
065  
066  
067  
068  
069  
070  
071  
072  
073  
074  
075  
076  
077  
078  
Message  
Rec No.  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
015  
016  
017  
018  
019  
020  
021  
022  
023  
024  
025  
026  
027  
028  
029  
030  
031  
032  
033  
034  
035  
036  
037  
038  
039  
Message  
Gross sales total  
Net sales total  
Not used  
Rounding  
ST transfer void  
Not used  
Cash in drawer  
Cash declared amount (not used)  
Declared short cash amount (not used)  
Declared over cash amount (not used)  
Charge in drawer  
Charge declared amount (not used)  
Declared short charge amount (not used)  
Declared over charge amount (not used)  
Check in drawer  
Check declared amount (not used)  
Declared short check amount (not used)  
Declared over check amount (not used)  
Credit in drawer  
Credit declared amount (not used)  
Declared short credit amount (not used)  
Declared over credit amount (not used)  
Not used  
Not used  
Taxable amount 1  
Tax 1  
Tax exempt 1  
Taxable amount 2  
Tax 2  
Tax exempt 2  
Taxable amount 3  
Tax 3  
Tax exempt 3  
Taxable amount 4  
Tax 4  
Tax exempt 4  
Taxable amount 5  
Tax 5  
Tax exempt 5  
Taxable amount 6  
Tax 6  
Tax exempt 6  
Taxable amount 7  
Tax 7  
Tax exempt 7  
Taxable amount 8  
Tax 8  
Tax exempt 8  
Taxable amount 9  
Tax 9  
Tax exempt 9  
Taxable amount 10  
Tax 10  
Tax exempt 10  
Euro cash in drawer  
Euro charge in drawer  
Euro check in drawer  
Euro credit in drawer  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Refund mode total  
Customer count  
Average sales per customer  
Check cashing service fee  
New Balance fee  
Not used  
Clerk commission 1 total  
Clerk commission 2 total  
Foreign currency cash in drawer 1  
Foreign currency check in drawer 1  
Foreign currency cash in drawer 2  
Foreign currency check in drawer 2  
Foreign currency cash in drawer 3  
Foreign currency check in drawer 3  
Reduction  
Item return  
Clear counter  
7-2-3-5. Group character  
GROUP01  
GROUP02  
GROUP03  
0001-006Group character/Record No./File No.  
0002-006  
0003-006  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-3-7. Special character  
@No / *  
NoCTX  
X BUSY  
0001-023Special character/Record No./File No.  
0002-023  
0003-023  
:
:
T6 T7 T8 T9 T10  
0058-023  
Rec No.  
Contents  
Descriptor  
$ @No / *  
@No / *  
Amount symbol (3), @(2), No (2), split pricing (1),  
U.S.  
Others  
001  
Training filler (1)  
002  
003  
No. of item sold (2), Customer count (2), Square (6), Double sized customer count(6)  
NoCTX  
COVERS  
Multiplication (6)  
BUSY  
BUSY  
T1 T2 T3 T4 T5  
T12T13T14 T23  
T1  
U.S.  
Others  
Recalling for a check (6)  
Taxable symbol 1 (3 each)  
Taxable symbol 2 (3 each)  
Taxable symbol 3 (3 each)  
X
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
015  
016  
017  
018  
019  
020  
021  
022  
023  
024  
025  
026  
027  
028  
029  
030  
031  
032  
033  
034  
035  
036  
037  
038  
039  
040  
041  
042  
043  
044  
045  
046  
047  
048  
049  
050  
051  
052  
053  
054  
055  
056  
057  
058  
Foreign currency × 4 (2 each), Selective item symbol × 3 (1 each), Center dot (1)  
* * * * •  
REG  
PnX/Z  
Mode symbol 1 (4 each)  
Mode symbol 2 (4 each)  
Mode symbol 3 (4)  
RFR-  
MGR  
TRG  
Decimal of amount, Decimal of quantity, Delimiter (1 each)  
A.M., P.M. (3 each)  
..,  
AM PM  
CONTINUED  
Slip continued (12), page (2)  
Online password (8)  
Display subtotal symbol (ST key) (16)  
Subtotal symbol (16)  
Total symbol (16)  
Change symbol (16)  
Check cashing fee (16)  
Check cashing amount (16)  
Bon message (16)  
Not used  
Check No. (12)  
Service total (16)  
Item discount total (16)  
House Bon quantity of item (16)  
Seat No. (16)  
Total symbol (X/Z report) (16)  
Clock-in symbol (16)  
Clock-out symbol (16)  
Break-in symbol (16)  
Break-out symbol (16)  
Job code symbol (16)  
P
SUBTOTAL  
ST  
TL  
CG  
-
CACG  
** STUB **  
CHECK No.  
SRVC TL  
DISCOUNT  
HOUSE BON QTY  
SEAT#  
TL  
CLOCK-IN  
CLOCK-OUT  
BREAK-IN  
BREAK-OUT  
JOB  
WORK TIME  
BREAK TIME  
CASH TIP  
REGULAR TIME  
OVER TIME  
IN OUT BRK JOB#  
TIP WORK*  
COST  
NET SALES/HOUR  
COST/TRANSACTION  
EUREUR  
Work time symbol (16)  
Break time symbol (16)  
Tip declaration symbol (16)  
Regular work hours (Employee report) (16)  
Overtime work hours (Employee report) (16)  
Employee report (1) (4 each)  
Employee report (2) (4 each), Edit symbol (1)  
Hourly labor pay (16)  
Hourly labor proceeds (16)  
Pay per transaction (16)  
Euro amount symbol (3)  
not used  
Occupied new check (Open check report) (16)  
Finalized check (Open check report) (16)  
not used  
NEW OPEN  
FINALIZED  
not used  
Unit price of shift PLU 1 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 2 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 3 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 4 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 5 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 6 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 7 (PLU report)  
Unit price of shift PLU 8 (PLU report)  
Taxable symbol 4 (3 each)  
@1  
@2  
@3  
@4  
@5  
@6  
@7  
@8  
T6 T7 T8 T9 T10  
P-174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-3-8. Report header  
FIXED TTL  
0001-024Report header/Record No./File No.  
FREE FUNCTION  
SUB DEPT  
0002-024  
0003-024  
:
:
TIME ATTENDANCE  
0017-024  
Rec No.  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
015  
016  
017  
018  
019  
020  
021  
022  
023  
:
Contents  
Fixed totalizer report  
Transaction key report  
Subdepartment report  
PLU report  
Department report  
Group report  
Cashier/clerk report  
not used  
Hourly sales report  
Monthly sales report  
Flash (Financial) report  
Open check report  
Table analysis report  
PLU stock report  
Void causal report  
Descriptor  
FIXED TTL  
FREE FUNCTION  
SUB DEPT  
PLU  
DEPT  
GROUP  
CASHIER/CLERK  
HOURLY  
MONTHLY  
FLASH  
OPEN CHK  
TABLE ANALYSIS  
PLU STOCK  
VOID REASON  
Electronic journal report E-JOURNAL  
Time & Attendance  
Hourly labor  
Hourly item  
not used  
IDC (1) reset  
IDC (2) reset  
IDC (3) reset  
EMPLOYEE  
HOURLY LABOR  
HOURLY PRODUCT  
IDC(1) Clear  
IDC(2) Clear  
IDC(3) Clear  
030  
not used  
7-2-3-9. Endorse message  
0001-033  
ENDORSE MESSAGE 1  
0002-033  
Record No./File No.  
Endorse message  
ENDORSE MESSAGE 2  
0003-033  
ENDORSE MESSAGE 3  
0004-033  
ENDORSE MESSAGE 4  
7-2-3-10. GT character  
GT1  
GT2  
GT3  
0001-020GT character/Record No./File No.  
0002-020  
0003-020  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-4 Machine feature  
7-2-4-1. Pulldown group  
LIST01  
0001-026Record No./File No.  
000000 0000000000D168D167, D6~D1  
0101-004 PLU0101  
0102-004 PLU0102  
0103-004 PLU0103  
:
Link PLU, PLU 2nd@ Record No./File No./Descriptor  
:
0120-004 PLU0120  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Maximum number of stay down  
Status = 0  
The number of stay down = 1 ~ 8,  
No limit = 9  
Significant  
number  
:
D168  
Minimum number of stay down  
Status = 0  
The number of stay down = 1 ~ 8,  
No limit = 9  
Significant  
numbers  
:
D167  
Significant  
numbers  
PLU / Pulldown group  
Record number (1)  
: : : :  
D166 D165 D164 D163  
;
Always 0”  
D162  
Significant  
numbers  
PLU / Pulldown group  
File number (1)  
: : :  
D161D160D159  
Significant  
numbers  
PLU / Pulldown group  
Record number (2)  
: : : :  
D158 D157 D156 D155  
;
Always 0”  
D154  
Significant  
numbers  
PLU / Pulldown group  
File number (2)  
: : :  
D153D152D151  
Significant  
numbers  
PLU / Pulldown group  
Record number (20)  
: : : :  
D14 D13 D12 D11  
Significant  
numbers  
PLU / Pulldown group  
File number (20)  
: : : :  
D10 D9 D8 D7  
; ~ ;  
Always 000000”  
D6 ~ D1  
P-176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-4-2. Set menu table  
0001-028  
Record No./File No.  
0001-004 PLU0001  
0002-054 PLU0002  
0003-004 PLU0003  
Link PLU, PLU 2nd@, Pulldown group  
Record No./File No./Descriptor  
0002-028  
0003-028  
:
:
7-2-4-3. Arrangement  
0001-038 ABCDEF  
Record No./File No./Parameter  
0002-038  
0003-038  
:
:
7-2-4-4. Batch X/Z  
0001-029  
0002-029  
001112151700000000Record No./File No./Parameter  
101112151700000000  
0003-029  
011112151700000000  
:
:
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow to issue read report.  
Allow to issue reset report.  
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D18  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Read = 0  
Reset = 4  
Read/Reset selection (direct issuance)  
Reported area:  
Daily area = 0, Periodic 1 area = 1,  
Periodic 2 area = 2, Consolidation area = 3  
Significant  
number  
:
D17  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
Report code 1  
Report code 2  
Report code 3  
Report code 4  
Report code 5  
Report code 6  
Report code 7  
Report code 8  
D16 D15  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D14 D13  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D12 D11  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D10 D9  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D8 D7  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D4 D3  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-4-5. General feature  
D12D11D10D9D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1  
0001-022  
0002-022  
0003-022  
0004-022  
0005-022  
0006-022  
220000000000Record No./File No./Parameter *  
*
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000002002  
*
*
*
*
000000000200  
:
:
*
0034-022  
0035-022  
064907570000  
000000000000  
*
* Refer to each record format.  
Record 0001-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number (0 ~ 3)  
Date order:  
:
D12  
Year/Month/Day = 0/1, Day/Month/Year = 2, Month/Day/Year = 3  
Significant  
number (0 ~ 3)  
Monetary mode:  
0 = 0, º0 = 1, º00 = 2, º000 = 3  
:
D11  
; ; ; ; ;  
Always 00000”  
Always 00000”  
D10 D9 D8 D7 D6  
; ; ; ; ;  
D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Record 0002-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
: : : :  
Machine number  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
P-178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0003-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
Reset consecutive number after daily fixed totalizer reset report  
is issued.  
:
D8  
;
D7  
Always 0”  
: : : : : :  
Consecutive number start value:  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Record 0004-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Rounding:  
Significant  
number (0 ~ 5)  
:
D10  
No rounding = 0, IF1 = 1, IF2 = 2, Denmark = 3,  
Norway = 4, Singapore = 5  
Tax system:  
VAT = 0, US = 1, Canada = 2,  
Singapore = 3  
Significant  
number (0 ~ 3)  
:
D9  
:
D8  
Always 0”  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
a
Allow amount tender in RF/REGmode operation.  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
Cash drawer opening:  
1 Immediately when the transaction is finalized.  
2 After validation compulsory is released.  
1 = 0  
2 = 4  
b
; ;  
D6 D5  
Always 00”  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
High amount limit specification for money in drawer amount.  
(Sentinel function)  
: :  
D4 D3  
Number 0f  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
; ;  
D2 D1  
Always 00”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0005-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
:
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Always issu a receipt.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
Print total line during finalization.  
:
Time system:  
1 24 hour system, 2 12 hour system  
1 = 0  
2 = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Feed one line after issuing receipt.  
;
D9  
Always 0”  
Breakdown set menu printing.  
(Receipt, slip, guest receipt and display)  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D8  
; ; ;  
Always 000”  
D7 D6 D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
Print number of item sold.  
Print tax symbols.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print finalization of single item receipt.  
Always 0”  
;
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
a
b
a
b
c
Print customer header by double sized character.  
Print unit price on receipt.  
Print clear key operation.  
Print number of customers on header.  
Print PLU No. on receipt.  
:
(a+b)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D1  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
P-180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0006-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Follow the taxable status and commission status of +/to the  
a
b
c
previous item.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Restrict 0 or 5 on the last digit.  
Display operator guidance.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
;
D11  
Always 0”  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
Accumulate to periodic totals after daily reset operation.  
Force to declare the money in drawer. (Inline X/Z)  
Force to declare the money in drawer.  
Force to press subtotal before finalization.  
Allow credit balance while finalization.  
Allow multiple refund/register minus mode operation.  
Affect the result of +/, %+/%to the item.  
Include add-on tax in net total.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Include commission in net total.  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
a
Sounds key confirmation tone.  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
b
Allow to issue post receipt, even if the original one is issued.  
:
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Connect slit drawer.  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
a
b
a
b
c
Prohibit registration when the stock quantity becomes negative.  
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Alert when the stock quantity becomes under minimum stock  
quantity.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Affect to stock quantity even if the refund operation.  
Merge refund item registration to the original one.  
(Item consolidation)  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Allow one registration of +/, %+/%per one transaction.  
Round on the least significant digit of %+/%registration.  
Allow numeric entry while compulsory drawer opening.  
Use <YES> key to select an item.  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
PLU numbering:  
By memory No. (Sequential) = 0, By random code = 4  
Significant  
number  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0008-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Print gross total.  
Print net total.  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print cash in drawer.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Print cash in drawer difference. (future)  
Print charge in drawer.  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print charge in drawer difference. (future)  
Print check in drawer.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Print check in drawer difference. (future)  
Print credit in drawer.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Print credit in drawer difference. (future)  
Print refund mode total.  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Print number of customers.  
Print average sales per customer.  
Print check cashing fee total.  
Print new balance fee total.  
Print commission 1 total.  
Print commission 2 total.  
Print foreign currency in drawer.  
Print discount total.  
a
b
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
(a+b)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Print refund total.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print clear counter.  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
Print rounding total.  
D3  
; ;  
Always 00”  
D2 D1  
P-182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0009-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Print taxable amount 1.  
Print tax 1.  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print tax exempt 1.  
Print taxable amount 2.  
Print tax 2.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print tax exempt 2.  
Print taxable amount 3.  
Print tax 3.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print tax exempt 3.  
Print taxable amount 4.  
Print tax 4.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print tax exempt 4.  
Print taxable amount 5.  
Print tax 5.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print tax exempt 5.  
Print taxable amount 6.  
Print tax 6.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print tax exempt 6.  
Print taxable amount 7.  
Print tax 7.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print tax exempt 7.  
Print taxable amount 8.  
Print tax 8.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print tax exempt 8.  
Print taxable amount 9.  
Print tax 9.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print tax exempt 9.  
Print taxable amount 10.  
Print tax 10.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D1  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print tax exempt 10.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0010-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Print taxable amount 1.  
Print taxable amount 2.  
Print taxable amount 3.  
Print taxable amount 4.  
Print taxable amount 5.  
Print taxable amount 6.  
Print taxable amount 7.  
Print taxable amount 8.  
Print taxable amount 9.  
Print taxable amount 10.  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D9  
; ; ;  
D8 D7 D6  
Always 000”  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Prohibit registration,  
1 while all drawers open, 2 while clerks own drawer opens.  
:
D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D4 D3  
Till timer (00 ~ 59 minutes)  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
Till timer (00 ~ 59 seconds)  
P-184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0012-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
Print grand total 1 (periodic 1 & 2 report).  
Print grand total 2 (periodic 1 & 2 report).  
Print grand total 3 (periodic 1 & 2 report).  
Print grand total 1 (daily report).  
Print grand total 2 (daily report).  
Print grand total 3 (daily report).  
Always 000”  
:
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Print the average of the monthly report.  
D1  
Record 0013-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D12  
Broadcast the program data after completion of a program.  
; ; ;  
D11 D10 D9  
Always 000”  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
Print Z collection/consolidation result.  
Reset Z collection/consolidation result.  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Copy stock quantity from consolidation file to daily file after  
Z consolidation.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Retry to poll the terminal which has not responded for the first  
polling.  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Allow inline master operation.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D6  
Print report before Z collection/consolidation.  
Source file selection:  
1 Terminal file, 2 Consolidation file  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
a
:
(a+b)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
b
Add to the consolidation file after Z operation.  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0014-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Print = 0  
Print/Display fixed totalizer read report.  
Print/Display transaction read report.  
Print/Display department/subdepartment read report.  
Print/Display PLU/stock read report.  
Print/Display group read report.  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
Display = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Print = 0  
Display = 2  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
:
(a+b)  
D11  
Display = 1  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
Print/Display clerk read report.  
Display = 1  
:
Print = 0  
Print/Display hourly/monthly read report.  
Print/Display open check read report.  
Print/Display table analysis read report.  
Print/Display journal memory read report.  
Print/Display hourly item read report.  
Print/Display employee read report.  
Print/Display hourly/labor read report.  
Display = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
Display = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
Display = 1  
:
Print = 0  
Display = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
;
D7  
Always 0.  
Print = 0  
Print/Display fixed totalizer reset report.  
Print/Display transaction reset report.  
Print/Display department/subdepartment reset report.  
Print/Display PLU/stock reset report.  
Print/Display group reset report.  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
Display = 1  
:
Print = 0  
Display = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
Display = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
Print/Display clerk reset report.  
Display = 1  
:
Print = 0  
Print/Display hourly/monthly reset report.  
Print/Display open check reset report.  
Print/Display table analysis reset report.  
Print/Display E-journal reset report.  
Print/Display hourly item reset report.  
Print/Display employee reset report.  
Print/Display hourly/labor reset report.  
Print/Display employee activity read report.  
Print/Display financial report.  
Display = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
Display = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D3  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
Display = 1  
:
Print = 0  
Display = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D2  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
Print = 0  
:
(a+b)  
D1  
Display = 2  
Print = 0  
Display = 4  
P-186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0015-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
Zero-skip department/subdepartment report.  
:
(a+b)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Zero-skip clerk report.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Zero-skip transaction report.  
Zero-skip PLU report.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Zero-skip hourly report.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Zero-skip group report.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Zero-skip monthly report.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Zero-skip table analysis report.  
Zero-skip hourly item report.  
Zero-skip hourly labor report.  
Zero-skip shift PLU.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D8  
; ;  
D7 D6  
Always 00”  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
:
Print PLU No. on the PLU report.  
Print sales ratio.  
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Issue double Z report.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print the recalculate amount of taxable amount and tax amount.  
Print consecutive No. range of the day on the fixed total report.  
Reset stock after batch reset report.  
Print reset counter.  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Print item discount totalizer.  
1 = 0  
2 = 4  
Printing order of PLU report:  
1 Memory No. (sequential), 2 Random code  
;
Always 0”  
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0016-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Interval time of hourly report (00 ~ 23 hours)  
Significant  
number  
: : : :  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
Interval time of hourly report (00 ~ 59 minutes):  
(0000treats as 01:00.)  
Start time of hourly report (00 ~ 23 hours)  
Start time of hourly report (00 ~ 59 minutes)  
Significant  
number  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
P-188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0017-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
Money declaration compulsory (cash). (future)  
Money declaration compulsory (charge). (future)  
Money declaration compulsory (check). (future)  
Money declaration compulsory (credit). (future)  
Print double-hight characters in UP-350.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Classify registered items by group in receipt.  
Classify registered items by department in receipt.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Classified item printing format:  
1 Total, 2 Detail with total  
1 = 0  
2 = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Include VAT amount in commission subtotal.  
Print total line in classified item printing.  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Rounding of commission:  
Round off = 0, cut off = 1, round up = 2  
Significant  
number  
:
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
Append two zeros in unit price programming.  
Capture the details of the copy guest receipt in electronic journal.  
Skip the consecutive No. of the electronic journal.  
Print date on receipt.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Print date on journal.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print consecutive number on receipt/journal.  
Print time on receipt.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Print time on journal.  
Merge the same department/PLU registration on receipt.  
(Item consolidation)  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Auto-cut receipt/report.  
D2  
;
Always 0”  
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0018-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
: :  
D10 D9  
Significant  
numbers  
Maximum printing lines of slip (00 ~ 99)  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Classify registered items by group on slip & guest receipt.  
Classify registered items by department on slip & guest receipt.  
a
b
c
:
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Classified item printing format:  
1 Total, 2 Detail with total  
1 = 0  
2 = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
Print total line in classified item printing format.  
Always 0”  
D7  
;
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Slip back feed after slip printing. *  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Slip back feed after validation printing. *  
Slip back feed after check printing/check endorsement printing. *  
Print date on slip & guest receipt.  
(a+b+c)  
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Print time on slip & guest receipt.  
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Print consecutive No. on slip & guest receipt.  
Slip print range:  
1 From the top of the transaction, 2 This receipt  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Enable slip auto line find.  
Merge the same department/PLU registration on slip &  
guest receipt. (Item consolidation)  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
Slip auto feed lines.  
* These programs are only effective for SP-1300.  
P-190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0019-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
:
D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Record operations in training mode on journal/electronic journal.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Alert electronic journal memory near-end/full error.  
D1  
Record 0020-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Print receipt logo message.  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
:
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Print receipt commercial message.  
Print receipt bottom message.  
Print slip commercial message.  
Print slip bottom message.  
Print slip intermediate message.  
Print bill top message.  
(a+b+c)  
D12  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Print bill copy message.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print bill bottom message.  
Receipt logo data:  
1 Character type, 2 Graphic type  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Print commercial message on X/Z report.  
Always 0000”  
; ; ; ;  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0021-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Print order with order character.  
Print order with amount.  
Print double bon message.  
Breakdown set menu printing on order.  
Alert when the order printer is down.  
Always 00000”  
a
b
a
b
:
(a+b)  
D12  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D10  
; ~ ;  
D9 ~ D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Cut order.  
a
b
a
b
:
(a+b)  
D4  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print hyphens.  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Output orders during training.  
:
(a+b)  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Merge the same department/PLU registration on order receipt.  
(Item consolidation)  
Significant  
number  
:
No. of feed lines before order cutting. (0 ~ 9)  
No. of feed lines after order cutting. (0 ~ 9)  
D2  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
Record 0022-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D12 D11 D10 D9  
Start record number of scanning PLU link.  
; ~ ;  
Always 00000000”  
D8 ~ D1  
Record 0025-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Number of details for post entry (0 ~ 9)  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Calculate detail item prices in set menu.  
(If No, calculate only quantity and stock.)  
:
D2  
Significant  
number  
Set menu / Pulldown link type:  
Fine dining = 1, Fast food = 2, Fine dining quantity = 3  
:
D1  
P-192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0026-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Check tracking method:  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
a
1 Check No., 2 Table No.  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
Maximum digit of check No.:  
1 6-digit, 2 12-digit  
1 = 0  
2 = 4  
b
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Tax calculation by new balance.  
Print previous balance, when registering old check.  
Always 000”  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D7  
; ; ;  
D6 D5 D4  
Merge the same department/PLU registration by old check.  
(Item consolidation)  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
:
D3  
Display detail items of the previous check  
when registering <OLD CHK>.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
;
(a+b)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Item consolidation when registering <SEP CHK>.  
Capture the item data  
b
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
Record 0027-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
:
D12  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Enable clerk interrupt.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
:
Enable to register a clerk who has no clerk number.  
Always 0000”  
D11  
; ; ; ;  
D10 D9 D8 D7  
; ; ; ;  
D6 D5 D4 D3  
Always 0000”  
Auto sign-off timer.  
(00 ~ 99 seconds, 00means no auto sign-off.)  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
Record 0028-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
: :  
Significant  
numbers  
Back light off timer (00 ~ 59 minutes, 00means never turn off.)  
D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0029-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
:
Significant  
number  
Sheet No. of the 1st parent menu sheet.  
Summed up menu sheet 1 to parent 1.  
Summed up menu sheet 2 to parent 1.  
Summed up menu sheet 3 to parent 1.  
Summed up menu sheet 4 to parent 1.  
Summed up menu sheet 5 to parent 1.  
Summed up menu sheet 6 to parent 1.  
Summed up menu sheet 7 to parent 1.  
Summed up menu sheet 8 to parent 1.  
Sheet No. of the 2nd parent menu sheet.  
Summed up menu sheet 1 to parent 2.  
Summed up menu sheet 2 to parent 2.  
Summed up menu sheet 3 to parent 2.  
Summed up menu sheet 4 to parent 2.  
Summed up menu sheet 5 to parent 2.  
Summed up menu sheet 6 to parent 2.  
Summed up menu sheet 7 to parent 2.  
Summed up menu sheet 8 to parent 2.  
Always 000”  
D12  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
:
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Significant  
number  
:
D8  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Sum up manu sheets to one sheet.  
a
:
(a+b)  
D1  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Reset child menu sheets with parent menu sheet together.  
b
P-194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0031-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Enable quantity extension of touch PLU.  
Enable quantity extension of touch subdepartment.  
Enable quantity extension of touch department.  
Always 000000”  
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
;;;;;;  
D11 D10 D9 D8 D7 D6  
; ; ; ; ;  
D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 00000”  
Record 0032-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D12 D11 D10 D9  
Start PLU number of 1st menu sheet  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
Start PLU number of 2nd menu sheet  
Start PLU number of 3rd menu sheet  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Record 0033-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D12 D11 D10 D9  
Start PLU number of 4th menu sheet  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
Start PLU number of 5th menu sheet  
Start PLU number of 6th menu sheet  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Record 0034-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
Start PLU number of 7th menu sheet  
Start PLU number of 8th menu sheet  
Always 0000”  
D12 D11 D10 D9  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0035-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Full aged employee:  
Weekly work time (00 ~ 99 hours)  
Weekly work time (00 ~ 59 minutes)  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D12 D11 D10 D9  
Minor employee:  
Weekly work time (00 ~ 99 hours)  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
Weekly work time (00 ~ 59 minute)  
Allow EMPLOYEE Z even if employee are not clocked-out.  
Use Weekly / Bi-weekly  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Weekly = 0  
Bi-weekly = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Enable clerk to sign on after clock-in  
Always 0”  
;
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Recognize break time as work time  
D2  
Rounding of work hours  
No rounding = 0,  
per 10 minutes = 1; 00 ~ 04 = 00, 05 ~ 09 = 10 (min.),  
per 15 minutes = 2; 00 ~ 07 = 00, 08 ~ 14 = 15 (min.),  
per 20 minutes = 3; 00 ~ 10 = 00, 11 ~ 19 = 20 (min.),  
per 30 minutes = 4; 00 ~ 15 = 00, 16 ~ 29 = 30 (min.)  
:
Significant  
number  
D1  
Record 0036-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Reset the Store/Recall starting number. (after Open check Z)  
D9  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
Store/Recall starting number (0000 = 0001) *  
Store/Recall ending number (0000 = 9999) *  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
* Be sure that all terminals have common value.  
* The starting number should be smaller than the ending number.  
Record 0037-022  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
Auto check starting number (0000 = 0001) *  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
Auto check ending number (0000 = 9999) *  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
* Be sure that all terminals have common value.  
* The starting number should be smaller than the ending number.  
P-196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-4-6. Scheduler  
D16D15D14D13D12D11D10D9D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1  
0001-062  
0002-062  
0003-062  
0004-062  
0000000000000000Record No./File No./Parameter (D28 ~ D13)  
000000000000Parameter (D12 ~ D1)  
0000000000000000  
000000000000  
0000000000000000  
000000000000  
0000000000000000  
000000000000  
Description  
Scheduler start time (00:00 ~ 23:59)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D28 D27 D26 D25  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D24 D23 D22 D21  
Scheduler end time (00:00 ~ 23:59)  
;
D20  
Always 0”  
Significant  
number  
Interval control 1:  
Daily = 0, Weekly = 1, Monthly = 2  
:
D19  
Interval control 2:  
Daily; No meaning  
Weekly; Define day of a week  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D18 D17  
00; Sunday, 01; Monday, 02; Tuesday, 03; Wednesday,  
04; Thursday, 05; Friday, 06; Saturday  
Monthly; Define date, 01 ~ 31, 99 means the end of the month  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
Interval time (00:00 ~ 23:59)  
Always 0”  
D16 D15 D14 D13  
;
D12  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
Arrangement table No.  
Arrangement file No.  
Always 0000”  
D11 D10 D9 D8  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
D7 D6 D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-4-7. Check print  
D6D5D4D3D2D1  
0001-041  
0002-041  
0003-041  
0004-041  
000000Record No./File No./Parameter  
000000  
000000  
000000  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Define printing data:  
1; Printing amount  
3; Printing date  
2; Printing amount (double size)  
4; Printing date (double size)  
Significant  
number  
:
D5  
5; Check endorsement message 1st line  
6; Check endorsement message 2nd line  
7; Check endorsement message 3rd line  
8; Check endorsement message 4th line  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
Feed before printing.  
Normal = 0  
Reverse = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Feed direction  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Feed 1 line after printing.  
No. of feed lines before printing (0 ~ 9)  
Printing offset digits (00 ~ 49)  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
7-2-4-8. Table analysis  
D6D5D4D3D2D1  
TBL01  
TBL02  
0001-018Table analysis descriptor/Record No./File No.  
000000Parameter (Minimum check No.)  
000000Parameter (Maximum check No.)  
0002-018  
000000  
000000  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Minimum check No. of the group  
(0means 1.)  
Significant  
numbers  
::::::  
D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7  
Maximum check No. of the group  
(000000means no programming.)  
Significant  
numbers  
::::::  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
P-198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-4-9. Tax table  
0001-025  
TX1  
Record No./File No.  
10%Tax rate  
TX1  
TX1  
0000Table maximum value  
50Rounding code  
TX1  
02Table attribution  
0002-025  
TX2  
TX2  
10%  
0000  
50  
TX2  
TX2  
02  
7-2-4-10. Void table  
Mistake  
001-012Void reason character/Record No./File No.  
000000Parameter  
002-012  
Out of Date  
000000  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Return stock value.  
D1  
7-2-4-11. System connection  
0001-901 MC #01  
0002-901  
0003-901  
020101000000Record No./File No./Id character/Parameter  
000000000000  
000000000000  
000000000000  
0004-901  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
::::::  
D24 D23 D22 D21 D20 D19  
Significant  
characters  
Logical ID characters (within 12 characters)  
::::::  
D18 D17 D16 D15 D14 D13  
Terminal:  
Oneself = 02, Others = 01  
: :  
D12 D11  
Significant  
numbers  
Check tracking master/backup master (program value):  
Master = 01, Backup master = 02, Self master = 03, Satellite = 00  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D10 D9  
Check tracking master/backup master (current value):  
Master = 01, Backup master = 02, Self master = 03, Satellite = 00  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D8 D7  
; ; ;;;  
Always 00000”  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2  
Check tracking cluster number (0 ~ 9)  
(0means no designation.)  
:
D1  
Significant  
number  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-4-12. I/O parameter  
0001-902  
0002-902  
0003-902  
0004-902  
0000000000Record No./File No./Parameter  
0000000000  
0000000000  
0000000000  
Record 0001  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Inline baud rate:  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
312kbps = 0*, 156kbps = 1  
* For INLINE 2 (CAT5) cable, select 312kbps only.  
Record 0002  
Description  
57600bps = 2,  
9600bps = 5,  
Choice  
Program code  
Online baud rate: 115200bps = 0,1  
Significant  
number  
:
38400bps = 3,  
4800bps = 6,  
19200bps = 4,  
2400bps = 7  
D2  
Activation signal (trigger):  
DR = 0, CI = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
Record 0003  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
;
Always 0”  
D1  
Record 0004  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
No. of offset digits of slip/validation printing by SA-3015 (00 ~ 24)  
Always 000”  
D10D9  
; ; ;  
D8 D7 D6  
:
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Use SA-3015 printer for slip printing:  
Using RS-232C port for printer:  
COM4 = 0, COM5 = 5, COM6 = 6  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Baud rate of the RS-232C port for printer:  
19200bps = 0, 9600bps = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Using printer connected to RS-232C port: No printer = 99  
Significant  
numbers  
UP-350 = 00  
SA-3015 = 01  
UP-250 = 02  
: :  
D2 D1  
P-200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 0005  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
No. of offset digits of slip/validation printing by SA-3015 (00 ~ 24)  
Always 000”  
D10D9  
; ; ;  
D8 D7 D6  
:
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Use SA-3015 printer for slip printing:  
D5  
Using RS-232C port for printer:  
COM5 = 0, COM4 = 4, COM6 = 6  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Baud rate of the RS-232C port for printer:  
19200bps = 0, 9600bps = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Using printer connected to RS-232C port: No printer = 99  
Significant  
numbers  
UP-350 = 00  
SA-3015 = 01  
UP-250 = 02  
: :  
D2 D1  
Record 0006  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Rear display:  
Connected * = 1, Not connected = 0  
Significant  
number  
:
D2  
Remote display:  
Connected * = 1, Not connected = 0  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
* You can connect either rear or remote display.  
Record 0007  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Display color:  
White line/black ground = 0, Black line/white ground = 1  
:
D1  
Record 0008  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
;
D1  
Always 0”  
Record 0009  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Parity:  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Even = 0, Non = 1, Odd = 2  
Bit:  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
7 bit = 0, 8 bit = 1  
Scanner:  
Connect = 2, No = 0  
Significant  
number  
:
D2  
Baud rate:  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
2400 bps = 0, 9600 bps = 1, 4800 bps = 2  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 0010  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Using RS-232C port for printer:  
No printer = 0, COM2 = 2 (COM 4 = 4, COM 5 = 5, COM 6 = 6)  
:
D4  
Significant  
number  
Baud rate of the RS-232C port for slip printer:  
No printer = 0, 9600bps = 1  
:
D3  
SP-1300:  
Connect = 70, No = 00  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D2 D1  
Record 0011  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
No. of offset digits of slip/validation printing by SA-3015 (00 ~ 24)  
D10D9  
; ; ;  
Always 000”  
D8 D7 D6  
:
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Use SA-3015 printer for slip printing:  
D5  
Using RS-232C port for printer:  
COM6 = 0, COM4 = 4, COM5 = 5  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Baud rate of the RS-232C port for printer:  
19200bps = 0, 9600bps = 1  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Using printer connected to RS-232C port: No printer = 99  
Significant  
numbers  
UP-350 = 00  
SA-3015 = 01  
UP-250 = 02  
: :  
D2 D1  
P-202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-4-13. Printer definition  
0001-903 MC #01  
/1  
01Record No./File No./Printer Name/Attribution  
MC #02  
/2  
0002-903 MC #01  
/10  
/2  
50  
MC #01  
:
:
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Kind of printer:  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
No = 00, R/J = 01, Report = 02, Order#1 = 50,  
D30 D29  
Order#2 = 51, Order#7 = 56  
ECR ID characters connecting with main printer  
(within 12 characters)  
Significant  
characters  
: ~ :  
D28 ~ D17  
ECR ID characters connecting with backup printer  
(within 12 characters)  
Significant  
characters  
: ~ :  
D16 ~ D5  
Main printer number:  
Printer (1) = 00 or 01, Printer (2) = 02, Printer (3) = 03  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D4 D3  
Backup printer number:  
Printer (1) = 00 or 01, Printer (2) = 02, Printer (3) = 03  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
7-2-4-14. Time Zone  
0001-800  
0001-800  
000000000000Record No./File No./Significant number  
000000000000  
:
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
: :  
D12 D11  
Zone start time (hour)  
00 ~23  
: :  
Zone start time (minute) (00~59)  
Zone end time (hour) (00~23)  
Zone end time (minute) (00~59)  
Zone cycle (hour) (00~23)  
00 ~ 59  
00 ~ 23  
D10 D9  
: :  
D8 D7  
: :  
D6 D5  
00 ~ 59  
: :  
D4 D3  
00 ~ 23  
: :  
D2 D1  
Zone cycle (minute) (00, 15, 30, 45)  
00, 15, 30, 45  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-4-15. Employee  
HARRISON  
CLAPTON  
123456  
9999999999  
0001-801Employee#/Character/Record No./File No.  
0001020304Social security No./Program (D12~D3)  
HARRISONClerk character  
000001  
0002-801  
0000000000  
0000000000  
--------(No clerk character is set.)  
:
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Employee No. (within a 6-digits: 000000~999999)  
(000000means no select number)  
Reading zerocan be ignored. eg) 001234 1234  
Significant  
number  
: ~ :  
D44 ~ D39  
Significant  
character  
: ~ :  
Character (16-degits)  
D38 ~ D23  
Significant  
number  
Social security No. (within a 10-digits)  
Reading zerocannot be ignored. eg) 0001234567 0001234567  
: ~ :  
D22 ~ D13  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
Specify job code  
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Clock-in without job code or with undefined Job  
Use the job code window during clock-in operation  
Enable to clock-in with ignoring the schedule  
Minor employee  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
:
(a+b)  
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Significant  
number  
Job code 1 (00 ~ 99)  
(00means no select number)  
: :  
D10 D9  
Significant  
number  
Job code 2 (00 ~ 99)  
(00means no select number)  
: :  
D8 D7  
Significant  
number  
Job code 3 (00 ~ 99)  
(00means no select number)  
: :  
D6 D5  
Significant  
number  
Job code 4 (00 ~ 99)  
(00means no select number)  
: :  
D4 D3  
Significant  
number  
: :  
Cashier/clerk record number (00 ~ 99)  
D2 D1  
P-204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-4-16. Job Code  
COOK  
0001-802Character/Record No./File No.  
00  
00  
@9999.99  
@0.00  
12.34Programming (D12D11) /Pay rate/Overtime pay ratio  
0002-802  
0.00  
JOB#2  
:
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
character  
: ~ :  
Character (within a 16-digit) (No character means no setting.)  
Tip declaration compulsory during clock-out operation  
Always 0”  
D28 ~ D13  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D12  
;
D11  
Significant  
number  
: ~ :  
Pay rate ($0.00 ~ $9999.99)  
D10 ~ D5  
Significant  
number  
Overtime pay ratio (0.00 ~ 99.99)  
(0.00means 1.00)  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-4-17. Schedule  
Monday  
JOB#1  
(1)  
(2)  
0001-803Day of the week/Shift No./Rec#~File#  
000000000000Job character/Programming (D20 ~ D9)  
00000000Programming (D8 ~ D1)  
0002-803  
Monday  
JOB#2  
000000000000  
00000000  
:
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Job code (00 ~ 99)  
(00means no select number)  
: :  
D22 D21  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D20 D19  
Start time (hour) (00 ~ 23)  
Significant  
number  
: :  
Start time (minute) (00 ~ 59)  
End time (hour) (00 ~ 23)  
D18 D17  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D16 D15  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D14 D13  
End time (minute) (00 ~ 59)  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D12 D11  
Break time (hour) (00 ~ 23)  
Significant  
number  
: :  
Break time (minute) (00 ~ 59)  
Grace before start (minute) (00 ~ 99)  
Grace after start (minute) (00 ~ 99)  
Grace before end (minute) (00 ~ 99)  
Grace after end (minute) (00 ~ 99)  
D10 D9  
: :  
Significant  
number  
D8 D7  
: :  
Significant  
number  
D6 D5  
: :  
Significant  
number  
D4 D3  
: :  
Significant  
number  
D2 D1  
P-206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-4-18. IDC Link  
0001-804 0001-004 PLU0001  
Record No./File No./Target Record No.-File No./Character  
1010Programming (D12 ~ D9)  
0001-804 0001-026 PLU0001  
:
2000  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
;
Always 0”  
D12  
Significant  
number  
Specify IDC Link file  
No link=0, IDC(1)=1, IDC(2)=2, IDC(3)=3  
:
D11  
;
Always 0”  
D10  
Significant  
number  
Target for IDC:  
All transactions=0, Only item/function=1  
:
D9  
Significant  
number  
: : : :  
Record No. of the target for IDC  
Always 0”  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
;
D4  
Significant  
number  
: : :  
D3 D2 D1  
File No. of the target for IDC  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-5 Clerk  
7-2-5-1. Clerk feature  
C01  
001-007Clerk name/Record No./File No.  
0001Clerk secret code  
00Drawer No.  
000111Clerk No. for clerk interrupt  
0000040000Refer to the record 01-067 †  
0000000000Refer to the record 02-067 †  
0000000000Refer to the record 03-067 †  
01-067  
02-067  
03-067  
04-067 000000000000Refer to the record 04-067 †  
05-067 000000000000Refer to the record 05-067 †  
06-067 000000000000Refer to the record 06-067 †  
07-067 000000000000Refer to the record 07-067 †  
08-067 000000000000Refer to the record 08-067 †  
09-067 000000000000Refer to the record 09-067 †  
10-067 000000000000Refer to the record 10-067 †  
11-067 000000000000not used  
068  
00000000Commission rate †  
069 000000000000Table range †  
C02  
002-007  
0002  
Refer to the record format below.  
:
:
Table range  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Minimum value for table range (1 ~ 999999)  
(0means no programming.)  
Significant  
numbers  
::::::  
D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7  
Maximum value for table range (1 ~ 999999)  
(0means no programming.)  
Significant  
numbers  
::::::  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Commission rate  
Description  
Commission rate 1 (0.01 ~ 99.99%)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
: : : :  
numbers  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
(with decimal)  
Significant  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Commission rate 2 (0.01 ~ 99.99%)  
numbers  
(with decimal)  
P-208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 01-067  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
:
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Check number compulsory  
Table number compulsory  
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D9  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Number of customer compulsory  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Guest receipt compulsory (at finalization)  
Guest receipt compulsory (at new balance)  
Slip auto-batch print compulsory (at finalization)  
Slip auto-batch print compulsory (at new balance)  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D8  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Clerk attribution:  
Cashier = 0, Clerk = 1, Manager = 2  
Significant  
number  
:
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D6  
Training clerk  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Enable to open check created by other clerk  
Disable to sign on  
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Sign off at finalization  
Always 0”  
;
D4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Seat number compulsory  
Eat-in/Take-out compulsory  
Always 0”  
a
:
(a+b)  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
;
D2  
Void operation:  
Complete void = 0, Current transaction = 1, Not allowed = 2  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 02-067  
Description  
Enable to use 1st menu sheet.  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to use 2nd menu sheet.  
Enable to use 3rd menu sheet.  
Enable to use 4th menu sheet.  
Enable to use 5th menu sheet.  
Enable to use 6th menu sheet.  
Enable to use 7th menu sheet.  
Enable to use 8th menu sheet.  
Always 000”  
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
; ; ;  
D7 D6 D5  
Default shift PLU sheet number after sign on. (0 ~ 8)  
(Do not set the disabled sheet No.,  
0means maintaining previous menu sheet.)  
Significant  
number  
:
D4  
Default menu sheet number after sign on. (0 ~ 8)  
(Do not set the disabled sheet No.,  
0means maintaining previous menu sheet.)  
Significant  
number  
:
D3  
Default @ menu sheet number after sign on. (0 ~ 2)  
(Do not set the disabled sheet No.,  
0means maintaining previous menu sheet.)  
:
Significant  
number  
D2  
Status = 0  
Status/stay down menu sheet assignment  
Status/stay down @ menu sheet assignment  
a
Stay down = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D1  
Status = 0  
Stay down = 2  
b
P-210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 03-067  
Description  
Enable to operate in REG mode.  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate in REF mode.  
Enable to operate in REGmode.  
Always 0”  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
;
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate in PGM1 mode.  
Enable to operate in PGM2 mode.  
Enable to operate in PGM3 mode.  
Enable to operate in PGM4 mode.  
Enable to operate in PGM5 mode.  
Enable to operate in PGM6 mode.  
Always 0”  
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
;
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate in X/Z mode.  
Enable to operate in Manager mode.  
Enable to operate in collection/consolidation mode.  
Enable to operate in Auto-PGM mode  
Enable to operate in CF card Auto-PGM mode  
Always 00”  
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b+c)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
; ;  
D3 D2  
Significant  
number  
Default mode after sign on:  
REG = 0, PGM1 = 1, X/Z = 2  
:
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 04-067  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate cash.  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
c
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
Enable to operate charge.  
Enable to operate check.  
Enable to operate credit.  
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate new balance.  
Enable to operate price inquiry.  
Enable to operate stock inquiry.  
Enable to operate text recall.  
Enable to operate text print.  
Enable to operate check print.  
Enable to operate clerk transfer.  
Enable to operate table transfer.  
Enable to operate tip.  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
;
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D7  
Enable to operate normal receipt.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate loan.  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate received on account.  
Enable to operate paid out.  
Enable to operate pick up.  
Enable to operate coupon.  
Enable to operate deposit.  
Enable to operate minus.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate percent minus.  
Enable to operate plus.  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate percent plus.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D2  
Enable to operate refund.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D1  
Enable to operate coupon 2.  
P-212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 05-067  
Description  
Enable to operate validation.  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate receipt.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate check endorse.  
Enable to operate non add.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate non add/no sale.  
Enable to operate no sale.  
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate No. of customer  
Enable to operate arrangement.  
Enable to operate currency exchange.  
Enable to operate VAT.  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate bill copy.  
;
D8  
Always 0.  
:
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate slip back feed/release.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate slip print.  
Enable to operate slip feed/release.  
Enable to operate tax shift.  
a
b
c
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate table number.  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate money declaration.  
Enable to operate shift PLU.  
Enable to operate menu shift.  
Enable to operate tax exempt.  
Enable to operate open.  
a
b
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D3  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate preset open.  
Enable to operate 1st@.  
(a+b+c)  
D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate 2nd@.  
:
(a+b)  
D1  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate clerk No.  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 06-067  
Description  
Enable to operate operator X/Z.  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to tray total.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate subtotal.  
Enable to operate receipt on/off.  
Enable to operate TA/ST.  
Enable to operate operator No.  
Enable to operate MD/ST.  
Enable to operate X.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate X/For.  
Enable to operate X/XX.  
Enable to operate X/XXX.  
Enable to operate Ketten Bon.  
Enable to operate selective item ST.  
Always 00”  
(a+b+c)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
; ;  
D6 D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate new check.  
Enable to operate old check.  
Enable to operate new/old check.  
Enable to operate add check.  
Enable to operate separate check.  
Always 00”  
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D3  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
; ;  
D2 D1  
P-214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 07-067  
Description  
Enable to operate substitution.  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
:
(a+b)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate House Bon.  
b
;
D11  
Always 0”  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate operator open check.  
Enable to operate media change.  
Enable to operate seat number.  
Enable to operate display on/off.  
Enable to operate REG mode.  
Enable to operate X/Z mode  
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Enable to operate PGM mode.  
Enable to operate post entry.  
Enable to operate round repeat.  
Enable to operate eat-in.  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate take-out.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate store.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate recall.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate reverse display.  
Enable to operate Electronic journal display.  
Enable to operate home position.  
Enable to operate display mode change.  
Enable to operate dutch account.  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
;
D3  
Always 0”  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
Enable to operate all void of this transaction.  
Enable to operate all void from the top of this receipt.  
D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 08-067  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to operate price.  
Enable to operate PLU No.  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable to operate subdepartment No.  
Enable to operate department No.  
Enable to operate list No.  
Enable to operate flat PLU.  
Enable to operate department key.  
Enable to operate subdepartment key.  
Enable to operate list key.  
Always 0000”  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D9  
; ; ; ;  
D8 D7 D6 D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
P-216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 09-067  
Description  
Enable to operate arrange group 1.  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to operate arrange group 2.  
Enable to operate arrange group 3.  
Enable to operate arrange group 4.  
Enable to operate arrange group 5.  
Always 00000”  
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
; ; ; ; ;  
D10 D9 D8 D7 D6  
; ; ; ; ;  
D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 00000”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 10-067  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to issue daily X report.  
a
b
a
b
a
b
:
(a+b)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable to issue daily Z report.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to issue periodic 1 X report.  
Enable to issue periodic 1 Z report.  
Enable to issue periodic 2 X report.  
Enable to issue periodic 2 Z report.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
;
Always 0”  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 1 report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 2 report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 3 report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 4 report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 5 report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 6 report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 7 report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 8 report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 9 report.  
Enable to issue employee X/Z report.  
Enable to issue employee edit report.  
Enable to issue batch X/Z 10 report.  
Enable to issue operator X report.  
Enable to issue operator Z report.  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
; ;  
Always 00”  
D3 D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable to issue X/Z report by file.  
Enable to issue individual key/item X/Z report.  
Enable to issue other individual X/Z report.  
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
P-218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-5-2. Clerk detail  
0001-030 0001-001 GROSS  
0002-030 0002-001 NET  
0003-030 0003-001 CAID  
Record No./File No./Detailed total record No./  
File No./Character  
7-2-5-3. Clerk key ID (Dallas key ID)  
1234567890AB  
0001-027 Key ID./Record No./File No.  
0001 Clerk name/Clerk record No.  
0002-027  
0002  
C
12362458DA79  
C
01  
02  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-6 Key feature  
7-2-6-1. PLU  
PLU0001  
0001-004PLU descriptor/Record No./File No.  
000000000000Elementary program †  
000000Refer to the record 11-066 †  
000000Refer to the record 12-066 †  
0000Refer to the record 13-066 †  
0Refer to the record 14-066 †  
@0.00High amount limit  
11-066  
12-066  
13-066  
14-066  
15-066  
16-066  
17-066  
20-066  
21-066  
22-066  
00Refer to the record 16-066 †  
00Refer to the record 17-066 †  
0000Refer to the record 20-066 †  
00000000Refer to the record 21-066 †  
000000not used  
PLU0002  
0002-004  
7-2-6-2. PLU 2nd unit price  
PLU0001  
0001-054PLU 2nd @ descriptor/Record No./File No.  
000000000000Elementary program †  
000000Refer to the record 11-066 †  
000000Refer to the record 12-066 †  
0002-004  
11-066  
12-066  
PLU0002  
000000000000  
11-066  
12-066  
000000  
000000Refer to the record 12-066 †  
0003-004  
PLU0003  
7-2-6-3. Subdepartment  
SUBDEPT01  
0001-003Subdepartment descriptor/Record No./File No.  
000000000000Elementary program †  
000000Refer to the record 11-066 †  
@0.00High amount limit  
11-066  
15-066  
16-066  
17-066  
20-066  
00Refer to the record 16-066 †  
00Refer to the record 17-066 †  
0000Refer to the record 20-066 †  
00000000Refer to the record 21-066 †  
0002-003  
21-066  
SUBDEPT02  
7-2-6-4. Department  
DEPT01  
0001-005Department descriptor/Record No./File No.  
000000000000Elementary program †  
000000Refer to the record 11-066 †  
@0.00High amount limit  
11-066  
15-066  
16-066  
17-066  
20-066  
00Refer to the record 16-066 †  
00Refer to the record 17-066 †  
0000Refer to the record 20-066 †  
00000000Refer to the record 21-066 †  
0002-005  
21-066  
DEPT02  
Refer to the following record formats.  
P-220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Elementary program  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Single item control: (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
Normal receipt = 0, Single item receipt = 3  
:
D12  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Selective item status 1 (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
Selective item status 2 (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
a
:
(a+b)  
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
Significant  
number  
Normal/condiment/preparation (Only effective for PLU)  
Normal item = 0, Condiment = 1, Preparation = 2  
:
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
U.S., Singapore:  
Taxable status 1  
a
b
c
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Taxable status 2  
Taxable status 3  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Canada:  
Taxable 1 = 01, Taxable 2 = 02, Taxable 3 = 03, Taxable 4 = 04  
Taxable 1 & 2 = 05, Taxable 1 & 3 = 06, Taxable 1 & 4 = 07  
Non taxable = 00  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D9 D8  
Significant  
number  
Other area:  
Taxable status 01 ~ 10 (00means Non-tax)  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Multiple validation (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
(If No, only one validation is possible.)  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Full hash (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
Open PLU (Only effective for PLU)  
Enable 0 unit price.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Enable negative price. (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
Hash (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
(a+b+c)  
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Register by unit price of pulldown main item.  
(i.e. ignore sub item unit price)  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Use premium item of pulldown set.  
Significant  
number  
Low digit limitation (LDL) for manually entered unit price.  
(Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
:
D4  
;
Always 0”  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Commission 1 (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
Commission 2 (Not effective for PLU 2nd@)  
Always 0”  
a
:
(a+b)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
;
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Record 11-066  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D6 D5  
Link subdepatment record number (for PLU and PLU 2nd@)  
Link department record number  
(for PLU PLU 2nd@ and subdepartment)  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D4 D3  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
Link group record number  
Record 12-066  
Description  
PLU random code (only for PLU)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
::::::  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Record 13-066  
Description  
Set menu table number (only for PLU)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Record 14-066  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Unit stock quantity (0.001 ~ 99.999)  
Significant : : : : :  
Enter with decimal point. (If 0, treats as 1.)  
numbers  
D12 D11 D10 D9 D8  
(for PLU and PLU 2nd@)  
;
D7  
Always 0”  
Minimum stock quantity (0.001 ~ 99.999)  
Enter with decimal point. (for PLU and PLU 2nd@)  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : : :  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2  
;
D1  
Always 0”  
Record 15-066  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
High amount limit for entering unit price manually.  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
Significant  
numbers  
::::::  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Record 16-066  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Order character record number (00 ~ 99)  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
P-222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record 17-066  
Description  
Number of Bon receipts (1 ~ 9)  
(If 0, no Bon is issued.) (not for PLU 2nd@)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
:
D1  
Record 20-066  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Order printing color: 1 Black: UP-250 (Normal : UP-350),  
2 Red: UP-250 (Reverse: UP-350) (not for PLU 2nd@)  
:
D4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Print out to order printer #1.  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Print out to order printer #2.  
not for PLU 2nd@)  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print out to order printer #3.  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Print out to order printer #4.  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
:
(a+b+c)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Print out to order printer #5.  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print out to order printer #6.  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Print out to order printer #7.  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
:
D1  
Record 21-066  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Pulldown group record number (1)  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D8 D7  
Pulldown group record number (2)  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D6 D5  
Pulldown group record number (3)  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D4 D3  
Pulldown group record number (4)  
(not for PLU 2nd@)  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-6-5. Function key  
0001 CASH  
000000000000Record No./Key descriptor/Parameter  
000000000000  
000000000000  
0002 CHARGE  
0003 CREDIT  
0004 %+  
000000000000  
0005 CLEAR  
0006 PGM MODE  
000000000000  
000000000000  
Programming for cash, charge, credit and check  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number (0 ~9)  
Allowable number of validation printing (0means no limitation)  
:
D11  
*1 *3 *4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Force validation operation. *1 *3 *4  
a
b
c
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Print check number barcode on receipt.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Restriction (to 00, 25, 50, 75) on last two digits for amount  
tendered (Only for <CASH> in Danish rounding)  
;
D9  
Always 0”  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Force batch slip printing. *1 *4  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b+c)  
D8  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Force check endorsement printing (Only for <CHECK>). *3 *4  
Force check printing (Only for <CHECK>). *3 *4  
Prohibit entry of a partial payment  
Prohibit the entry of the amount tendered.  
Force entry of the amount tendered.  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Print VAT breakdown. *1 *2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D6  
Check cashing commission (Only for <CHECK>) *3  
Amount = 0  
Rate = 2  
1 Use an amount  
2 Use a rate  
Validation amount *3  
1 Print subtotal amount 2 Print amount tendered  
Subtotal = 0  
Tender = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
No change due is made in tendering operation.  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Issue receipt while check tracking/clerk interrupt.  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
High amount limit specification for subtotal and tendering  
amounts. *3  
: :  
D4 D3  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
: :  
D2 D1  
High amount limit specification for change amount due.  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
P-224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
*1 Those are valid options for AUTO CASH as well.  
*2 Those are valid options for Single item as well.  
*3 Those are valid options for Cashing a check as well.  
*4 Those are valid options for Currency exchange (include partial tender) as well.  
Programming for new balance  
Description  
Allowable number of validation printing (0means no limitation)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number (0 ~9)  
:
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
Force validation operation.  
Print check number barcode on receipt.  
Always 0”  
:
(a+b)  
D10  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
;
D9  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
Force batch slip printing.  
Open drawer when the key is pressed.  
Always 0”  
:
(a+b)  
D8  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
;
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
Print VAT breakdown.  
Service charge  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
Amount = 0  
Rate = 2  
b
1 Use an amount  
2 Use a rate  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D5  
Issue receipt while check tracking/clerk interrupt.  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Programming for character print  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
Start record number of displaying TEXT RECALL WINDOW”  
(00means 01.)  
: :  
D9 D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow clerk or mode change after the text recallkey  
depression. (effective only for text recallkey)  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
D7  
Print characters to sales receipt printer.  
Significant  
number  
Order character record No. (01 ~ 99)  
(00clears programming)  
: :  
D6 D5  
Black = 0  
Red = 1  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
Printing color (effective only for order)  
Display/print with quantity.  
:
(a+b+c)  
D4  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Staydown TEXT RECALL WINDOW(only characters)  
Print characters to order printer 1.  
Print characters to order printer 2.  
Print characters to order printer 3.  
Print characters to order printer 4.  
Print characters to order printer 5.  
Print characters to order printer 6.  
Print characters to order printer 7.  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
P-226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming for check print  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
:
D7  
Number of back feed lines before printing (0 ~ 9)  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
Programming for clerk transfer  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Clerk number  
1 Memory number  
:
D7  
2 Clerk secret number  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
Programming for table transfer  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Allow to add checks while table transferring.  
Transfer the customer number.  
Transfer only total amounts. (ST transfer)  
Auto check transfer  
a
b
c
a
b
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Receipt is issued, even if the receipt switch is off.  
Print receipt.  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D5  
;;;;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
Programming for tip  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Multiple validation  
:
If No, only one validation printing is possible.)  
Always 0000”  
D11  
; ; ; ;  
D10 D9 D8 D7  
; ; ;  
D6 D5 D4  
Always 000”  
Significant  
number  
High digit limitation (HDL) for manually entered unit price  
(9means NOT allow manual entry)  
:
D3  
; ;  
D2 D1  
Always 00”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Programming for loan, pick up  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
:
Allowable number of validation printing (0means no limitation)  
Force validation operation. (only effective after receipt issuance)  
Always 00000”  
number (0 ~9)  
D11  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D10  
; ; ; ; ;  
D9 D8 D7 D6 D5  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
: :  
High amount limit specification for entering amounts  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
D4 D3  
; ;  
D2 D1  
Always 00”  
Programming for received on account, paid out  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number (0 ~9)  
:
D11  
Allowable number of validation printing (0means no limitation)  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D10  
Force validation operation.  
; ; ; ; ;  
D9 D8 D7 D6 D5  
Always 00000”  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
: :  
High amount limit specification for entering amounts  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
D4 D3  
;
D2  
Always 0”  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
Enter numbers after registration.  
P-228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming for plus, minus, coupon  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Multiple validation  
(If No, only one validation printing is possible.)  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D11  
;
D10  
Always 0”  
U.S., Singapore:  
Taxable status 1  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
Taxable status 2  
Taxable status 3  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Canada:  
Taxable 1 = 01, Taxable 2 = 02, Taxable 3 = 03, Taxable 4 = 04  
Taxable 1 & 2 = 05, Taxable 1 & 3 = 06,Taxable 1 & 4 = 07  
All taxable = 08, Non taxable = 00  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D9 D8  
Other area:  
Significant  
numbers  
Taxable status 01 ~ 10 (00means Non-tax)  
:
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
Allow credit balance. (, CPN only)  
Always 00”  
D7  
; ;  
D6 D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow key operation after <SUBTOTAL>.  
Allow key operation after item registration.  
a
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
b
High digit limitation (HDL) for manually entered unit price  
(9means NOT allow manual entry.)  
:
Significant  
number  
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Commission 1  
Commission 2  
Always 0”  
a
:
(a+b)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
b
;
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Programming for discount, premium  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Multiple validation  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
(If No, only one validation printing is possible.)  
Always 0”  
D11  
;
D10  
U.S., Singapore:  
Taxable status 1  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
b
c
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
Taxable status 2  
Taxable status 3  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Canada:  
Taxable 1 = 01, Taxable 2 = 02, Taxable 3 = 03, Taxable 4 = 04  
Taxable 1 & 2 = 05, Taxable 1 & 3 = 06,Taxable 1 & 4 = 07  
All taxable = 08, Non taxable = 00  
Significant  
numbers  
: :  
D9 D8  
Other area:  
Significant  
numbers  
Taxable status 01 ~ 10 (00means Non-tax)  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Allow manual override.  
All taxable  
a
:
(a+b)  
D7  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
b
:
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow key operation after <SI/ST>.  
:
D5  
Rounding:  
Round off = 0, cut off = 1, round up = 2  
Significant  
number  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Allow key operation after <SUBTOTAL>.  
Allow key operation after item registration.  
Always 0”  
a
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
b
;
D3  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Commission 1  
a
:
(a+b)  
D2  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Commission 2  
b
;
D1  
Always 0”  
P-230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming for deposit+, deposit–  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Force validation operation.  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
a
:
(a+b)  
D10  
(only effective after receipt issuance)  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
b
Multiple validation (If No, only one validation is possible.)  
; ;  
D9 D8  
Always 00”  
DEPO+ = 0  
:
Key attribution  
Open cash drawer.  
DEPO= 1  
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
:
D6  
Media definition:  
Cash = 0, charge = 1, check = 2, credit = 3  
Significant  
number  
:
D5  
Maximum  
value (0 ~ 9)  
: :  
D4 D3  
High amount limit specification for entering amounts  
Number of  
zeros (0 ~ 9)  
; ;  
D2 D1  
Always 00”  
Programming for void  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
:
D2  
Item delete (When Nois selected, only a line can be deleted.)  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
:
D1  
Select void reason.  
Programming for check endorsement  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
:
Line number of auto-back feed before printing (0 ~ 9)  
D7  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Programming for receipt  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Maximum number of post receipts (0 ~ 9)  
(0means 1 post receipt.)  
:
D12  
; ; ; ;  
D11 D10 D9 D8  
Always 0000”  
1 = 0  
2 = 2  
Form of post receipt and guest receipt:  
a
b
a
b
1 Print out, 2 Display  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Print current time on guest receipt.  
Clear finalized check.  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Issue post receipt after clerk interrupt/check tracking  
Always 00”  
; ;  
D5 D4  
Significant  
number  
Issue guest receipt to order printer n (n = 1 ~ 7).  
(0means issuing to R/J.)  
:
D3  
Significant  
number  
Line number of guest bottom message (00 ~ 10):  
(00means no bottom message.)  
: :  
D2 D1  
Programming for #, #/NS  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Allow mode change or clerk change after non add registration as  
first transaction. (only for non-add function)  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
:
D7  
Order character record number (00 ~ 99):  
(00means no setting.)  
Significant  
number  
: :  
D6 D5  
Red = 1  
Black = 0  
:
D4  
Order printing color  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
Print out to Order printer#1.  
Print out to Order printer#2.  
Print out to Order printer#3.  
Print out to Order printer#4.  
Print out to Order printer#5.  
Print out to Order printer#6.  
Print out to Order printer#7.  
a
b
c
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D3  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
:
(a+b+c)  
D2  
Yes = 2  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
No = 0  
:
D1  
P-232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming for arrangement  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Enable operation in REG mode.  
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
:
(a+b+c)  
D12  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable operation in REF mode.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Enable operation in REGmode.  
Enable operation in PGM1 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM2 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM3 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM4 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM5 mode.  
Enable operation in PGM6 mode.  
Enable operation in Auto PGM to CF card mode  
Enable operation in Auto PGM mode.  
Enable operation in X/Z mode.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
(a+b+c)  
D11  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D10  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b)  
D9  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D8  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Enable operation in Manager mode.  
Enable operation in Collection/Consolidation mode.  
Arrangement file number  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
D7 D6 D5  
Significant  
numbers  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Arrangement table number  
Programming for customer  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Input method:  
Allow replacement = 0, Prohibit replacement = 1,  
Add enter value = 2  
Significant  
number  
:
D7  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Programming for currency exchange  
Description  
Define amount symbol. (1 ~ 4)  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
:
D7  
Significant  
number  
:
D6  
Define foreign currency totalizer. (1 ~ 3)  
Significant  
number  
Rounding:  
Round off = 0, cut off = 1, round up = 2  
:
D5  
;
D4  
Always 0”  
Significant  
number  
Monetary mode (0 ~ 2):  
º00 = 2, º0 = 1, 0 = 0  
:
D3  
Decimal = 0  
Comma = 1  
Monetary symbol for decimal  
Monetary symbol for separator  
a
:
(a+b)  
D3  
Comma = 0  
Decimal = 4  
b
Significant  
number  
Assigning drawer number (0 ~ 2)  
(0means drawer 1.)  
:
D1  
Programming for slip  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Force slip batch printing from the beginning of the transaction.  
a
(If No, controlled by general function.)  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
No = 0  
Yes = 4  
Print current time on slip.  
(This option works only at batch print with whole transaction.)  
b
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
Clear finalized check.  
Always 0000”  
D6  
; ; ; ;  
D5 D4 D3 D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D1  
Print Euro total line.  
Programming for T/S, TAST  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
number  
Taxable status (00, 01 ~ 10)  
(00means taxable 1.)  
: :  
D9 D8  
; ; ;  
Always 000”  
Always 0000”  
D7 D6 D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
P-234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming for open  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Release high amount limit  
D7  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
Programming for open 2  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
Release customer number compulsory.  
Release table number compulsory.  
Release check number compulsory.  
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
c
a
b
a
b
a
b
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
(a+b+c)  
D7  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Release credit balance error. (If Yes, you can finalize the  
transaction even if the subtotal is negative.)  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Release guest receipt compulsory.  
Release validation compulsory.  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b+c)  
D5  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Release check endorsement compulsory.  
Release check print compulsory.  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Release slip auto batch print compulsory.  
Release slip manual batch print compulsory.  
Release <LIST> stay down compulsory (Min/Max No.).  
Release seat number compulsory.  
Release tip declaration compulsory.  
Release eat-in/take-out compulsory.  
Always 0”  
:
(a+b)  
D4  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D3  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
(a+b)  
D2  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
;
D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Programming for clerk number  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
Clerk secret number (0000 ~ 9999)  
(0000means no secret number.)  
: : : :  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Programming for operator X/Z  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
a
1 Issue stand-alone report./2 Issue consolidation report.  
1 Print report./2 Display report.  
Always 000000”  
:
(a+b)  
D7  
1 = 0  
2 = 2  
b
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Programming for subtotal, merchandise subtotal  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Multiple validation  
(If No, only one validation printing is possible.)  
Yes = 0  
No = 4  
:
D11  
; ; ; ; ;  
D10 D9 D8 D7 D6  
Always 00000”  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
Include add-on tax amount. (ST only)  
Print when key is pressed.  
Always 0000”  
:
(a+b)  
D5  
Yes = 4  
No = 0  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Programming for multiplication, quantity/for, square, cube, Ketten Bon  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Multiplication procedure: (Ketten Bon and <X> only)  
1 Quantity × Amount, 2 Amount × Quantity  
:
D6  
Significant  
number  
Rounding:  
Round off = 0, cut off = 1, round up = 2  
:
D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
P-236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming for selective item subtotal  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Selective item status (0, 1, 2):  
Selective item 1 = 0/1, selective item 2 = 2  
Significant  
number  
:
D11  
; ; ; ; ;  
Always 00000”  
Always 00000”  
D10 D9 D8 D7 D6  
; ; ; ; ;  
D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Programming for open check  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Display = 2  
Print = 0  
:
D7  
Display report./Print report  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
Programming for list  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
Record No. of linking pulldown menu group (4).  
D12 D11 D10  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
Record No. of linking pulldown menu group (3).  
Record No. of linking pulldown menu group (2).  
Record No. of linking pulldown menu group (1).  
D9 D8 D7  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
D6 D5 D4  
Significant  
numbers  
: : :  
D3 D2 D1  
Programming for cancel  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
2 = 0  
1 = 1  
A range of cancellation:  
a
1Complete cancellation, 2Current receipt only  
:
(a+b)  
D1  
No = 0  
Yes = 2  
Correct set menu/pulldown link while it is registered.  
b
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Programming for tax exempt  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
U.S., Singapore:  
Exempt tax 1  
a
b
c
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
Exempt tax 2  
Exempt tax 3  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
Canada:  
Exempt all = 00  
Significant  
numbers  
Exempt tax 1 = 01, Exempt tax 2 = 02, Exempt tax 3 = 03,  
Exempt tax 4 = 04, Exempt tax 1 & 2 = 05,  
: :  
D9 D8  
Exempt tax 1 & 3 = 06, Exempt tax 1 & 4 = 07  
Significant  
number  
Other area:  
Exempt all = 00, Exempt tax 1 ~ 10 = 01 ~ 10  
; ; ; ;  
Always 0000”  
Always 000”  
D7 D6 D5 D4  
; ; ;  
D3 D2 D1  
Programming for clock-in/clock-out  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
The purpose of uses:  
Significant  
numbers  
Use both clock-in and clock-out = 0  
Use only clock-in = 1  
:
D2  
Use only clock-out = 2  
Yes = 0  
No = 1  
:
D1  
Print when clock-in or clock-out keys are pressed.  
Programming for new check, new/old check  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D7  
Enable auto check assignment  
;;;;;;  
D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 000000”  
P-238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming for break-in/break-out  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
The purpose of uses:  
Significant  
numbers  
Use both break-in and break-out = 0  
Use only break-in = 1  
:
D2  
Use only break-out =2  
;
D1  
Always 0”  
Programming for eat-in/take-out  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 1  
Yes = 0  
U.S., Singapore:  
Exempt tax 1  
a
b
c
No = 2  
Yes = 0  
; :  
(a+b+c)  
D9 D8  
Exempt tax 2  
Exempt tax 3  
No = 4  
Yes = 0  
Canada:  
Exempt all = 00  
Significant  
number  
Exempt tax 1 = 01, Exempt tax 2 = 02, Exempt tax 3 = 03,  
Exempt tax 4 = 04, Exempt tax 1 & 2 = 05,  
Exempt tax 1 & 3 = 06, Exempt tax 1 & 4 = 07  
: :  
D9 D8  
Significant  
numbers  
Other area:  
Exempt all = 00, Exempt tax 1 ~ 10 = 01 ~ 10  
; ;  
D7 D6  
Always 00”  
Not print = 0  
Print = 4  
:
Print when the key is pressed.  
Always 0000”  
D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
Programming for store  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Print VAT breakdown.  
Print receipt.  
D6  
Yes = 0  
No = 2  
:
D5  
; ; ; ;  
D4 D3 D2 D1  
Always 0000”  
Programming for shift PLU  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
1 = 0  
2 = 1  
Shift:  
:
D2  
1 Status, 2 Staydown  
Significant  
number  
Define assigning shift PLU number. (0, 1 ~ 8)  
(0is treated as 1.)  
:
D1  
Programming for old check  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
D1  
Enable to open the finalized check.  
Programming for Dutch account  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
Significant  
numbers  
Maximum customer numbers for one Dutch account  
(00is treated as 99.)  
: :  
D2 D1  
Programming for tray total  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
Accumulate Tray totalto the key totalizer, whenever the  
<TRAY TOTAL> key is pressed twice.  
:
D1  
Programming for recall  
Description  
Choice  
Program code  
No = 0  
Yes = 1  
:
Enable to open the closed check.  
D1  
P-240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2-6-6. Scanning PLU link  
SCANNING USED RECS  
0002 / 0010  
Header/Used record No./Allocated record No.  
0001-016  
0002-016  
0003-016  
0004-016  
0005-016  
02833521>>>>> 0217Record No./File No./OBR code/Linked PLU record No.  
4987244235176 0218  
0000000000000 0000  
0000000000000 0000  
0000000000000 0000  
7-2-6-7. Euro program  
0001-099  
0002-099  
0003-099  
00000101Record No./File No./Program  
00000101  
00200117  
7-2-6-8. Auto-program control  
0001-905  
0002-905  
0003-905  
0902 01Record No./File No./Program  
0999 00  
0000 00  
QT-2100 Programming Manual  
P-241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6  
7-2-7 Keyboard  
1--------------------------------------Menu sheet number  
001.RCT  
0001 002 073Hard key code/Key descriptor/Record No./File No.  
002.NEW/OLD  
003.RC  
0002 002 093  
0003 002 091  
/Function code  
:
:
168.PLU0093  
0093 004 063  
2--------------------------------------  
001.RCT  
0001 002 073  
:
:
7-2-8 Memory allocation  
FILE001 26  
10  
59 DL P1 P2 WK  
File No./Length/Number of records/DL/P1/P2/WK  
CL/CL/CL  
CL CL CL  
FILE002 38  
10  
FILE003 54  
70 DL P1 P2 WK  
CL CL CL  
4 DL -- -- --  
DL: Daily total/PGM/work area, P1: Periodic 1 total  
P2: Periodic 2 total, P2: Periodic 2 total  
CL: Consolidation area of above file  
--means no file allocation.  
:
:
*means the file allocated in the flash.  
FILE020 24  
FILE045 30  
3 DL  
:
128 DL  
:
FILE989 30  
RAM  
1187 *DL  
:
153728  
Remaining RAM capacity  
P-242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index ...............................................................................................................P-244  
Program 3 mode Hierarchy.......................................................................................... P-247  
Program 1 mode Hierarchy.......................................................................................... P-248  
Program 2 mode Hierarchy.......................................................................................... P-248  
Program 6 mode Hierarchy.......................................................................................... P-248  
P-243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
D
Index  
Delete RF items from guest receipt P-43  
Department descriptors P-145  
Department features P-112  
Department unit price P-162  
DepositP-124  
Deposit+ P-124  
Destination of accumulation for menu totalizing P-56  
Display control P-55  
A
Accumulate touch PLU menus P-56  
Add mode P-41  
Allow finalization operation when subtotal is zero P-43  
Allow more than one transaction in RF mode P-43  
Allow numeric entries P-43  
Allow to operate Auto PGM P-84  
Allow to operate n-th Menu P-83  
Amount or rate to keys P-166, P-167  
Arrangement P-38, P-127  
Display Report P-48  
Dutch account P-134  
E
Employee P-74, P-204  
Endorsement message P-155  
Error when actual stock less than minimum stock P-43  
Error when actual stock less than zero P-43  
Euro P-78  
Arrangement control P-90  
Arrangement control by range P-102  
Auto program control P-79  
B
F
Batch X/Z report P-39  
Fixed totalizer descriptors P-151  
Flag clear QT-2100 terminal P-14  
Follow memu total reset operation P-56  
Follow the same QTY as main item P-53  
Function control 1 P-85  
Function control 1 by range P-97  
Function control 2 P-86  
Function control 2 by range P-98  
Function control 3 P-87  
Function control 3 by range P-99  
Function control 4 P-88  
Function control 4 by range P-100  
Function control 5 P-89  
Function control 5 by range P-101  
Function key descriptors P-148  
C
Calculate Price for detail P-53  
Calculation type P-62  
Cash P-118  
Cashier detail P-107  
Character programming P-140  
Character programming keyboard P-140  
Charge P-118  
Check P-118  
Check endorsement P-124  
Check print P-60, P-121  
Check tracking P-54  
Clearing CHK/TBL No. P-54, P-55  
Clerk P-54, P-74, P-77, P-80, P-81, P-82, P-94, P-  
208, P-219  
Clerk control P-82  
Clerk control by range P-94  
Clerk features P-80  
G
General feature P-41  
General procedure of PLU, PLU 2nd@, subdepartment, P-  
114  
Clerk interrupt P-54  
Clerk key ID P-107  
GT character P-155  
Clerk number P-130  
Clerk transfer P-121  
H
Hourly sales P-50  
Commission rate P-92  
Commission rate by range P-104  
Communication P-49  
Consecutive No. P-41  
Copy program change to other teminals P-49  
Copying PLU descriptors to PLU 2nd unit price P-147, P-  
165  
Coupon P-123  
Credit P-118  
Cube P-131  
Currency exchage P-128  
Customer P-127  
I
I/O parameter P-67  
IDC Link P-77, P-78, P-79, P-207  
IDC link P-77  
Initialize QT-2100 terminal P-8  
Inputting characters by code P-142  
Issue Post receipt when normal receipt is issued P-43  
Item Consolidation P-44  
Item descriptors P-143  
Item type P-109  
P-244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J
P
Job Code P-73, P-74, P-205  
Journal control P-51  
Paid out P-122  
Perform stock QTY calculation P-43  
Pick up P-122  
K
PLU 2nd unit price P-160  
PLU 2nd unit price descriptors P-144  
PLU 2nd@ features P-110  
PLU features P-108, P-136  
PLU item descriptors P-143  
PLU random code order P-48  
PLU unit price P-159  
Ketten Bon P-131  
Key allocation P-24  
Key location change P-26  
Keyboard layout P-27  
L
PLU unit price and PLU 2nd unit price P-161  
PLU/PLU 2nd@/subdepartment/department unit price P-  
163  
PLU/subdepartment/department descriptors P-146  
Post Entry P-53  
Limit of number Plus, Minus, Premium, Discount key P-42  
List P-71, P-79, P-131, P-132, P-133  
Loan P-122  
M
Presetting date and time P-158  
Print additional items only P-51  
Print control P-46  
Print Monthly Sales Average P-48  
Printer connection P-70  
Machine control 1 P-41  
Machine control 3 P-44  
Machine control 4 P-45  
Machine features P-34  
Machine number P-41  
Printer definition P-203  
Maximum Table Amount P-62  
Memory allocation P-16, P-17, P-18  
Menu shift 1 P-56  
Program read general procedure P-170  
Program read report sample P-171  
Programming hierchy of programming title P-115  
Pulldown group P-34  
Menu shift 2 P-57  
Menu shift after Sign On P-83  
Menu shift status/stay down P-83  
Menu shift/2nd@ P-83  
Menu shift/2nd@ by range P-95  
Merchandise subtotal P-130  
Message control P-52  
Q
Quantity/for P-131  
R
Random PLU P-42  
Recall P-134  
Receipt P-126  
Receipt Logo either graphic or text P-52  
Receipt message P-149  
Receipt on/off P-134  
Mode control P-84  
Mode control by range P-96  
Money declaration compulsory P-43  
Multiplication P-131  
N
Receipt type P-109  
Net total includes commission P-42  
Net total includes tax P-42  
New balance P-119  
Received on account P-122  
Remaining memory P-16  
Report control 2 P-48  
Report headers P-154  
Restrict (0 or 5) on the last digit P-43  
Rounding P-62  
O
Old check P-134  
Open 2 P-129  
Open check P-131  
Rounds %+ or %operation P-43  
Operator X/Z P-130  
Order character link P-150  
Order color P-109  
Order control P-52  
Order Print #1 ~ #7 P-109  
Origin of reset data to be sent to the master P-49  
Overwrite the J-Memo ring buffer P-51  
P-245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
S
Scanning PLU link P-136  
Schedule P-74, P-206  
Scheduler P-58  
Selective item subtotal P-131  
Sentinel amount P-41  
Set menu table P-36  
Set menu/condiment P-53  
Shift PLU P-134, P-135  
Slip P-128  
SLIP/Guest P-50  
Sort by department P-44  
Sort by group P-44  
Sort by group/dept with detail P-44  
Special characters P-152  
Square P-131  
ST compulsory P-43  
Stock result copy P-49  
Storage of TRG operation into journal memory P-50, P-51  
Subdepartment descriptors P-144  
Subdepartment features P-111  
Subdepartment unit price P-162  
Subtotal P-130, P-131  
System connection P-66  
T
T/S P-128  
Table analysis P-61  
Table range P-93  
Table range by range P-105  
Table transfer P-121  
TAST P-128  
Tax Rate(%) P-62  
Tax table P-62  
Text print P-120  
Text recall P-120  
Text recall message P-150, P-152  
Time & Attendance P-72, P-73, P-74  
Time zone P-71  
Tip P-121  
Tray total P-134  
Type of operator P-81  
V
VAT recaluculate on X/Z report P-48  
Void P-124  
Void operation P-81  
Void table P-65  
X
X/Z report control P-91  
X/Z report control by range P-103  
Z
Zero-Skip on Report P-48  
P-246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 3 mode Hierarchy  
Pulldown group ————————————————————————————Machine feature ———— Program 3  
Set menu table ———————————————————————————  
Arrangement ————————————————————————————  
Batch X/Z —————————————— General feature ———————  
Machine control 1 ~ 4 —————  
Print control —————————  
Report control 1, 2 ———————  
Communication ————————  
Hourly sales —————————  
SLIP/Guest ——————————  
Electronic journal control ————  
Message control ———————  
Order control —————————  
Set menu/condiment ——————  
Check tracking ————————  
Clerk interrupt—————————  
Display control ————————  
Menu shift 1, 2 ————————  
Scheduler —————————————————————————————  
Check print —————————————————————————————  
Table analysis————————————————————————————  
Tax table ——————————————————————————————  
Void table —————————————————————————————  
System connection —————————————————————————  
I/O parameter ————————————————————————————  
Printer connection ——————————————————————————  
Time Zone —————————————————————————————  
General ——————————————— Time & Attendance —————  
Job Code———————————  
Employee & Schedule —————  
Hourly Item Link ———————————————————————————  
IDC Link ——————————————————————————————  
Euro (Sub Currency) —————————————————————————  
Auto Pgm Control ——————————————————————————  
Clerk feature —————————————————————————————Clerk ————————  
Clerk control ————————————— Operation (individual) ————  
Menu shift/2nd ————————  
Mode control —————————  
Allowed function 1 ~ 5 —————  
Arrangement —————————  
Report ————————————  
Range (by range)  
Commission rate ——————————— (Individual) —————————  
Table range ——————————  
Range (by range)  
Clerk detail —————————————————————————————  
Clerk Key ID ————————————————————————————  
PLU ————————————————— (Individual) ——————————Key feature —————  
PLU 2nd @ ——————————  
Subdepartment ————————  
Department ——————————  
Range (by range)  
Receipt type ————————————— Individual program —————  
Item type ———————————  
Group link ——————————  
Department link ————————  
Subdepartment link ——————  
Taxable status ————————  
Commission —————————  
Selective item —————————  
Order color ——————————  
Order printer #1 ~ 7 ——————  
Order char link ————————  
No. of Bon ——————————  
Unit stock ——————————  
Minimum stock ————————  
Set menu table ————————  
List link #1 ~ 4 ————————  
Open PLU ——————————  
Zero unit price ————————  
Negative price ————————  
Hash item ——————————  
Full hash item —————————  
High amount limit ———————  
Low digit limit —————————  
Multiple validation ———————  
Function key ————————————————————————————  
Shift PLU ——————————————————————————————  
Scanning PLU Link —————————————————————————  
P-247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Program 1 mode Hierarchy  
PLU —————————————————————————————————— Unit price/Qty ————— Program 1  
PLU 2nd @ —————————————————————————————  
PLU & PLU 2nd @ —————————————————————————  
Subdepartment ———————————————————————————  
Department —————————————————————————————  
PLU by range ——————————————— Range—————————  
PLU 2nd @ by range ————————  
Subdepartment by range ———————  
Department by range ————————  
PLU 2nd@ Copy ——————————————————————————  
Amount/Rate to key —————————————————————————  
Shift PLU ——————————————————————————————  
Program 2 mode Hierarchy  
PLU —————————————————————————————————Item descriptor ————— Program 2  
PLU 2nd @ —————————————————————————————  
Subdepartment ———————————————————————————  
Department —————————————————————————————  
PLU by range ——————————————— Range—————————  
PLU 2nd @ by range ————————  
Subdepartment by range ———————  
Department by range ————————  
PLU > 2nd @ copy —————————————————————————  
Character & press key ————————————————————————  
Receipt/Slip message —————————————————————————Character & message —  
Text recall —————————————————————————————  
Order character link —————————————————————————  
Fixed totalizer ————————————————————————————  
Group character ———————————————————————————  
Special character ——————————————————————————  
Report header ———————————————————————————  
Endorse message ——————————————————————————  
GT character ————————————————————————————  
P-248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program 6 mode Hierarchy  
PLU unit price———————————— Unit price & quantity ——————— Program read report —— Program 6  
PLU 2nd @ ———————————  
Subdepartment unit price —————  
Department unit price ——————  
Function key rate/price ——————  
PLU ———————————————— Item descriptor ————————  
PLU 2nd @ ———————————  
Subdepartment —————————  
Department ———————————  
Function key ——————————  
Receipt/Slip message ———————— Character & message —————  
Text recall ———————————  
Order character link ———————  
Fixed totalizer character —————  
Group character —————————  
Special character ————————  
Report header —————————  
Endorse message ————————  
GT character ——————————  
Pulldown group ——————————— Machine feature ———————  
Set menu table —————————  
Arrangement ——————————  
Batch X/Z ———————————  
General feature —————————  
Scheduler ———————————  
Check print ———————————  
Table analysis——————————  
Tax table ————————————  
Void table ———————————  
System connection ———————  
I/O parameter ——————————  
Printer connection ————————  
Time zone ———————————  
Time&Attendance ————————  
Hourly item link —————————  
IDC link ————————————  
Euro (Sub Currency) ———————  
Auto Pgm Control ————————  
Clerk feature ———————————— Clerk ————————————  
Clerk detail ———————————  
Clerk Key ID ——————————  
PLU feature  
PLU 2nd @ feature ————————— Key feature —————————  
Subdepartment feature ——————  
Department feature ———————  
Function key feature ———————  
Scanning PLU Link ———————  
Keyboard——————————————————————————————  
Memory allocation ——————————————————————————  
P-249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
c
IR0202-003001-A  
CASIO COMPUTER CO., LTD.  
Printed in Japan  
QT-2100 PGM*E  
6-2, Hon-machi 1-chome  
Shibuya-ku, Tokyo 151-8543, Japan  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Belkin Network Card F5U103 User Manual
Bifinett Oven KH 1380 User Manual
Black Decker Rice Cooker HS2776 User Manual
Bradford White Corp Water Heater 500 B User Manual
Briggs Stratton Flat Panel Television 355ZB2654 DLR User Manual
Bryant Furnace 312AAV JAV User Manual
Carrier Air Conditioner 30HR User Manual
Cary Audio Design Stereo Amplifier Xciter User Manual
Char Broil Gas Grill 463460711 User Manual
Cisco Systems Network Card OL 10426 01 User Manual